US20170222400A1 - Optoelectronic integrated circuit - Google Patents
Optoelectronic integrated circuit Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20170222400A1 US20170222400A1 US15/450,400 US201715450400A US2017222400A1 US 20170222400 A1 US20170222400 A1 US 20170222400A1 US 201715450400 A US201715450400 A US 201715450400A US 2017222400 A1 US2017222400 A1 US 2017222400A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- layer
- type
- modulation doped
- waveguide
- terminal electrode
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Granted
Links
- 230000005693 optoelectronics Effects 0.000 title description 35
- 239000007943 implant Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 280
- 230000003287 optical effect Effects 0.000 claims abstract description 235
- 239000004065 semiconductor Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 36
- 238000000059 patterning Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 15
- 230000008878 coupling Effects 0.000 claims description 136
- 238000010168 coupling process Methods 0.000 claims description 136
- 238000005859 coupling reaction Methods 0.000 claims description 136
- 150000002500 ions Chemical class 0.000 claims description 135
- 125000006850 spacer group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 87
- 239000001301 oxygen Substances 0.000 claims description 37
- 229910052760 oxygen Inorganic materials 0.000 claims description 37
- -1 oxygen ions Chemical class 0.000 claims description 35
- 239000000758 substrate Substances 0.000 claims description 27
- 230000002441 reversible effect Effects 0.000 claims description 13
- 239000010410 layer Substances 0.000 description 645
- 239000002096 quantum dot Substances 0.000 description 59
- 230000004888 barrier function Effects 0.000 description 56
- 229910052751 metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 56
- 239000002184 metal Substances 0.000 description 56
- 229910000673 Indium arsenide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 52
- RPQDHPTXJYYUPQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N indium arsenide Chemical compound [In]#[As] RPQDHPTXJYYUPQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 52
- 108091006146 Channels Proteins 0.000 description 50
- 230000012010 growth Effects 0.000 description 38
- 238000010521 absorption reaction Methods 0.000 description 32
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 description 31
- 229910000530 Gallium indium arsenide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 29
- 238000002955 isolation Methods 0.000 description 29
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 description 29
- 229910045601 alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 25
- 239000000956 alloy Substances 0.000 description 25
- JBRZTFJDHDCESZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N AsGa Chemical compound [As]#[Ga] JBRZTFJDHDCESZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 24
- 238000001465 metallisation Methods 0.000 description 24
- 229910001218 Gallium arsenide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 23
- 238000005530 etching Methods 0.000 description 23
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 description 19
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 description 19
- 230000006870 function Effects 0.000 description 18
- 238000000151 deposition Methods 0.000 description 15
- 238000005468 ion implantation Methods 0.000 description 15
- 238000004519 manufacturing process Methods 0.000 description 14
- MDPILPRLPQYEEN-UHFFFAOYSA-N aluminium arsenide Chemical compound [As]#[Al] MDPILPRLPQYEEN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 12
- 230000000903 blocking effect Effects 0.000 description 12
- 229910001092 metal group alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 12
- 230000001902 propagating effect Effects 0.000 description 12
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 11
- 238000001514 detection method Methods 0.000 description 11
- 229910002059 quaternary alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 11
- 230000009471 action Effects 0.000 description 10
- 239000003989 dielectric material Substances 0.000 description 9
- 230000031700 light absorption Effects 0.000 description 9
- 238000005253 cladding Methods 0.000 description 8
- 230000000295 complement effect Effects 0.000 description 8
- 239000011241 protective layer Substances 0.000 description 8
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 description 7
- 238000006243 chemical reaction Methods 0.000 description 7
- 150000001875 compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 7
- 230000007423 decrease Effects 0.000 description 7
- 238000002347 injection Methods 0.000 description 7
- 239000007924 injection Substances 0.000 description 7
- 230000002093 peripheral effect Effects 0.000 description 7
- 229910000952 Be alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- 229910000990 Ni alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- 230000005669 field effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- WFKWXMTUELFFGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N tungsten Chemical compound [W] WFKWXMTUELFFGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 229910052721 tungsten Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- 239000010937 tungsten Substances 0.000 description 6
- 238000009792 diffusion process Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000003321 amplification Effects 0.000 description 4
- QVGXLLKOCUKJST-UHFFFAOYSA-N atomic oxygen Chemical compound [O] QVGXLLKOCUKJST-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 230000008901 benefit Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000005540 biological transmission Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000000969 carrier Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000008021 deposition Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000009826 distribution Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000007246 mechanism Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000003199 nucleic acid amplification method Methods 0.000 description 4
- 229920002120 photoresistant polymer Polymers 0.000 description 4
- 238000001228 spectrum Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000015556 catabolic process Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000005516 engineering process Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000035876 healing Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000007769 metal material Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000001451 molecular beam epitaxy Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000035945 sensitivity Effects 0.000 description 3
- 229910016909 AlxOy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 108091006149 Electron carriers Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 229910052581 Si3N4 Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 238000013459 approach Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000002019 doping agent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000002355 dual-layer Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000005684 electric field Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000007789 gas Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000020169 heat generation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000004047 hole gas Substances 0.000 description 2
- 150000004767 nitrides Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 230000006911 nucleation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000010899 nucleation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000003647 oxidation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000007254 oxidation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000037361 pathway Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000010363 phase shift Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000001020 plasma etching Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000002310 reflectometry Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000001338 self-assembly Methods 0.000 description 2
- HQVNEWCFYHHQES-UHFFFAOYSA-N silicon nitride Chemical compound N12[Si]34N5[Si]62N3[Si]51N64 HQVNEWCFYHHQES-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000002344 surface layer Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910000980 Aluminium gallium arsenide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229910000846 In alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 108090000699 N-Type Calcium Channels Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 108010075750 P-Type Calcium Channels Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 230000006978 adaptation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910001423 beryllium ion Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000002800 charge carrier Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000010276 construction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000007547 defect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000009977 dual effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005670 electromagnetic radiation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001914 filtration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910052731 fluorine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011737 fluorine Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000006260 foam Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000010348 incorporation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000010354 integration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000004048 modification Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012986 modification Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000035515 penetration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000737 periodic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012545 processing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000006798 recombination Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000005215 recombination Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002356 single layer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000003595 spectral effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000036962 time dependent Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000009466 transformation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005533 two-dimensional electron gas Effects 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/10—Construction or shape of the optical resonator, e.g. extended or external cavity, coupled cavities, bent-guide, varying width, thickness or composition of the active region
- H01S5/1071—Ring-lasers
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G02—OPTICS
- G02B—OPTICAL ELEMENTS, SYSTEMS OR APPARATUS
- G02B6/00—Light guides; Structural details of arrangements comprising light guides and other optical elements, e.g. couplings
- G02B6/10—Light guides; Structural details of arrangements comprising light guides and other optical elements, e.g. couplings of the optical waveguide type
- G02B6/12—Light guides; Structural details of arrangements comprising light guides and other optical elements, e.g. couplings of the optical waveguide type of the integrated circuit kind
- G02B6/13—Integrated optical circuits characterised by the manufacturing method
- G02B6/131—Integrated optical circuits characterised by the manufacturing method by using epitaxial growth
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G02—OPTICS
- G02B—OPTICAL ELEMENTS, SYSTEMS OR APPARATUS
- G02B6/00—Light guides; Structural details of arrangements comprising light guides and other optical elements, e.g. couplings
- G02B6/10—Light guides; Structural details of arrangements comprising light guides and other optical elements, e.g. couplings of the optical waveguide type
- G02B6/12—Light guides; Structural details of arrangements comprising light guides and other optical elements, e.g. couplings of the optical waveguide type of the integrated circuit kind
- G02B6/13—Integrated optical circuits characterised by the manufacturing method
- G02B6/134—Integrated optical circuits characterised by the manufacturing method by substitution by dopant atoms
- G02B6/1347—Integrated optical circuits characterised by the manufacturing method by substitution by dopant atoms using ion implantation
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G02—OPTICS
- G02B—OPTICAL ELEMENTS, SYSTEMS OR APPARATUS
- G02B6/00—Light guides; Structural details of arrangements comprising light guides and other optical elements, e.g. couplings
- G02B6/24—Coupling light guides
- G02B6/26—Optical coupling means
- G02B6/28—Optical coupling means having data bus means, i.e. plural waveguides interconnected and providing an inherently bidirectional system by mixing and splitting signals
- G02B6/293—Optical coupling means having data bus means, i.e. plural waveguides interconnected and providing an inherently bidirectional system by mixing and splitting signals with wavelength selective means
- G02B6/29331—Optical coupling means having data bus means, i.e. plural waveguides interconnected and providing an inherently bidirectional system by mixing and splitting signals with wavelength selective means operating by evanescent wave coupling
- G02B6/29335—Evanescent coupling to a resonator cavity, i.e. between a waveguide mode and a resonant mode of the cavity
- G02B6/29338—Loop resonators
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L21/00—Processes or apparatus adapted for the manufacture or treatment of semiconductor or solid state devices or of parts thereof
- H01L21/70—Manufacture or treatment of devices consisting of a plurality of solid state components formed in or on a common substrate or of parts thereof; Manufacture of integrated circuit devices or of parts thereof
- H01L21/77—Manufacture or treatment of devices consisting of a plurality of solid state components or integrated circuits formed in, or on, a common substrate
- H01L21/78—Manufacture or treatment of devices consisting of a plurality of solid state components or integrated circuits formed in, or on, a common substrate with subsequent division of the substrate into plural individual devices
- H01L21/82—Manufacture or treatment of devices consisting of a plurality of solid state components or integrated circuits formed in, or on, a common substrate with subsequent division of the substrate into plural individual devices to produce devices, e.g. integrated circuits, each consisting of a plurality of components
- H01L21/8252—Manufacture or treatment of devices consisting of a plurality of solid state components or integrated circuits formed in, or on, a common substrate with subsequent division of the substrate into plural individual devices to produce devices, e.g. integrated circuits, each consisting of a plurality of components the substrate being a semiconductor, using III-V technology
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L27/00—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate
- H01L27/02—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components specially adapted for rectifying, oscillating, amplifying or switching and having at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier; including integrated passive circuit elements with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier
- H01L27/04—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components specially adapted for rectifying, oscillating, amplifying or switching and having at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier; including integrated passive circuit elements with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier the substrate being a semiconductor body
- H01L27/06—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components specially adapted for rectifying, oscillating, amplifying or switching and having at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier; including integrated passive circuit elements with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier the substrate being a semiconductor body including a plurality of individual components in a non-repetitive configuration
- H01L27/0605—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components specially adapted for rectifying, oscillating, amplifying or switching and having at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier; including integrated passive circuit elements with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier the substrate being a semiconductor body including a plurality of individual components in a non-repetitive configuration integrated circuits made of compound material, e.g. AIIIBV
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L27/00—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate
- H01L27/02—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components specially adapted for rectifying, oscillating, amplifying or switching and having at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier; including integrated passive circuit elements with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier
- H01L27/04—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components specially adapted for rectifying, oscillating, amplifying or switching and having at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier; including integrated passive circuit elements with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier the substrate being a semiconductor body
- H01L27/08—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components specially adapted for rectifying, oscillating, amplifying or switching and having at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier; including integrated passive circuit elements with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier the substrate being a semiconductor body including only semiconductor components of a single kind
- H01L27/085—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components specially adapted for rectifying, oscillating, amplifying or switching and having at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier; including integrated passive circuit elements with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier the substrate being a semiconductor body including only semiconductor components of a single kind including field-effect components only
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L27/00—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate
- H01L27/14—Devices consisting of a plurality of semiconductor or other solid-state components formed in or on a common substrate including semiconductor components sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation
- H01L27/144—Devices controlled by radiation
- H01L27/1443—Devices controlled by radiation with at least one potential jump or surface barrier
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L29/00—Semiconductor devices adapted for rectifying, amplifying, oscillating or switching, or capacitors or resistors with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier, e.g. PN junction depletion layer or carrier concentration layer; Details of semiconductor bodies or of electrodes thereof ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/02—Semiconductor bodies ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/06—Semiconductor bodies ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor characterised by their shape; characterised by the shapes, relative sizes, or dispositions of the semiconductor regions ; characterised by the concentration or distribution of impurities within semiconductor regions
- H01L29/08—Semiconductor bodies ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor characterised by their shape; characterised by the shapes, relative sizes, or dispositions of the semiconductor regions ; characterised by the concentration or distribution of impurities within semiconductor regions with semiconductor regions connected to an electrode carrying current to be rectified, amplified or switched and such electrode being part of a semiconductor device which comprises three or more electrodes
- H01L29/083—Anode or cathode regions of thyristors or gated bipolar-mode devices
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L29/00—Semiconductor devices adapted for rectifying, amplifying, oscillating or switching, or capacitors or resistors with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier, e.g. PN junction depletion layer or carrier concentration layer; Details of semiconductor bodies or of electrodes thereof ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/02—Semiconductor bodies ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/12—Semiconductor bodies ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor characterised by the materials of which they are formed
- H01L29/15—Structures with periodic or quasi periodic potential variation, e.g. multiple quantum wells, superlattices
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L29/00—Semiconductor devices adapted for rectifying, amplifying, oscillating or switching, or capacitors or resistors with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier, e.g. PN junction depletion layer or carrier concentration layer; Details of semiconductor bodies or of electrodes thereof ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/02—Semiconductor bodies ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/36—Semiconductor bodies ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor characterised by the concentration or distribution of impurities in the bulk material
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L29/00—Semiconductor devices adapted for rectifying, amplifying, oscillating or switching, or capacitors or resistors with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier, e.g. PN junction depletion layer or carrier concentration layer; Details of semiconductor bodies or of electrodes thereof ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/66—Types of semiconductor device ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/66007—Multistep manufacturing processes
- H01L29/66075—Multistep manufacturing processes of devices having semiconductor bodies comprising group 14 or group 13/15 materials
- H01L29/66227—Multistep manufacturing processes of devices having semiconductor bodies comprising group 14 or group 13/15 materials the devices being controllable only by the electric current supplied or the electric potential applied, to an electrode which does not carry the current to be rectified, amplified or switched, e.g. three-terminal devices
- H01L29/66363—Thyristors
- H01L29/66401—Thyristors with an active layer made of a group 13/15 material
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L29/00—Semiconductor devices adapted for rectifying, amplifying, oscillating or switching, or capacitors or resistors with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier, e.g. PN junction depletion layer or carrier concentration layer; Details of semiconductor bodies or of electrodes thereof ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/66—Types of semiconductor device ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/68—Types of semiconductor device ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor controllable by only the electric current supplied, or only the electric potential applied, to an electrode which does not carry the current to be rectified, amplified or switched
- H01L29/70—Bipolar devices
- H01L29/74—Thyristor-type devices, e.g. having four-zone regenerative action
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L29/00—Semiconductor devices adapted for rectifying, amplifying, oscillating or switching, or capacitors or resistors with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier, e.g. PN junction depletion layer or carrier concentration layer; Details of semiconductor bodies or of electrodes thereof ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/66—Types of semiconductor device ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/68—Types of semiconductor device ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor controllable by only the electric current supplied, or only the electric potential applied, to an electrode which does not carry the current to be rectified, amplified or switched
- H01L29/76—Unipolar devices, e.g. field effect transistors
- H01L29/772—Field effect transistors
- H01L29/778—Field effect transistors with two-dimensional charge carrier gas channel, e.g. HEMT ; with two-dimensional charge-carrier layer formed at a heterojunction interface
- H01L29/7782—Field effect transistors with two-dimensional charge carrier gas channel, e.g. HEMT ; with two-dimensional charge-carrier layer formed at a heterojunction interface with confinement of carriers by at least two heterojunctions, e.g. DHHEMT, quantum well HEMT, DHMODFET
- H01L29/7783—Field effect transistors with two-dimensional charge carrier gas channel, e.g. HEMT ; with two-dimensional charge-carrier layer formed at a heterojunction interface with confinement of carriers by at least two heterojunctions, e.g. DHHEMT, quantum well HEMT, DHMODFET using III-V semiconductor material
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L31/00—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof
- H01L31/02—Details
- H01L31/0232—Optical elements or arrangements associated with the device
- H01L31/02327—Optical elements or arrangements associated with the device the optical elements being integrated or being directly associated to the device, e.g. back reflectors
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L31/00—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof
- H01L31/0248—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by their semiconductor bodies
- H01L31/0256—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by their semiconductor bodies characterised by the material
- H01L31/0264—Inorganic materials
- H01L31/0304—Inorganic materials including, apart from doping materials or other impurities, only AIIIBV compounds
- H01L31/03046—Inorganic materials including, apart from doping materials or other impurities, only AIIIBV compounds including ternary or quaternary compounds, e.g. GaAlAs, InGaAs, InGaAsP
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L31/00—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof
- H01L31/0248—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by their semiconductor bodies
- H01L31/0352—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by their semiconductor bodies characterised by their shape or by the shapes, relative sizes or disposition of the semiconductor regions
- H01L31/035209—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by their semiconductor bodies characterised by their shape or by the shapes, relative sizes or disposition of the semiconductor regions comprising a quantum structures
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L31/00—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof
- H01L31/0248—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by their semiconductor bodies
- H01L31/0352—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by their semiconductor bodies characterised by their shape or by the shapes, relative sizes or disposition of the semiconductor regions
- H01L31/035236—Superlattices; Multiple quantum well structures
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L31/00—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof
- H01L31/08—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof in which radiation controls flow of current through the device, e.g. photoresistors
- H01L31/10—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof in which radiation controls flow of current through the device, e.g. photoresistors characterised by at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier, e.g. phototransistors
- H01L31/101—Devices sensitive to infrared, visible or ultraviolet radiation
- H01L31/11—Devices sensitive to infrared, visible or ultraviolet radiation characterised by two potential barriers or surface barriers, e.g. bipolar phototransistor
- H01L31/1105—Devices sensitive to infrared, visible or ultraviolet radiation characterised by two potential barriers or surface barriers, e.g. bipolar phototransistor the device being a bipolar phototransistor
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L31/00—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof
- H01L31/08—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof in which radiation controls flow of current through the device, e.g. photoresistors
- H01L31/10—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof in which radiation controls flow of current through the device, e.g. photoresistors characterised by at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier, e.g. phototransistors
- H01L31/101—Devices sensitive to infrared, visible or ultraviolet radiation
- H01L31/111—Devices sensitive to infrared, visible or ultraviolet radiation characterised by at least three potential barriers, e.g. photothyristor
- H01L31/1113—Devices sensitive to infrared, visible or ultraviolet radiation characterised by at least three potential barriers, e.g. photothyristor the device being a photothyristor
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L31/00—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof
- H01L31/08—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof in which radiation controls flow of current through the device, e.g. photoresistors
- H01L31/10—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof in which radiation controls flow of current through the device, e.g. photoresistors characterised by at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier, e.g. phototransistors
- H01L31/101—Devices sensitive to infrared, visible or ultraviolet radiation
- H01L31/112—Devices sensitive to infrared, visible or ultraviolet radiation characterised by field-effect operation, e.g. junction field-effect phototransistor
- H01L31/1127—Devices with PN heterojunction gate
- H01L31/1129—Devices with PN heterojunction gate the device being a field-effect phototransistor
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L31/00—Semiconductor devices sensitive to infrared radiation, light, electromagnetic radiation of shorter wavelength or corpuscular radiation and specially adapted either for the conversion of the energy of such radiation into electrical energy or for the control of electrical energy by such radiation; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof
- H01L31/18—Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment of these devices or of parts thereof
- H01L31/184—Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment of these devices or of parts thereof the active layers comprising only AIIIBV compounds, e.g. GaAs, InP
- H01L31/1844—Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment of these devices or of parts thereof the active layers comprising only AIIIBV compounds, e.g. GaAs, InP comprising ternary or quaternary compounds, e.g. Ga Al As, In Ga As P
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L33/00—Semiconductor devices with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier specially adapted for light emission; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof
- H01L33/02—Semiconductor devices with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier specially adapted for light emission; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by the semiconductor bodies
- H01L33/04—Semiconductor devices with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier specially adapted for light emission; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by the semiconductor bodies with a quantum effect structure or superlattice, e.g. tunnel junction
- H01L33/06—Semiconductor devices with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier specially adapted for light emission; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by the semiconductor bodies with a quantum effect structure or superlattice, e.g. tunnel junction within the light emitting region, e.g. quantum confinement structure or tunnel barrier
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L33/00—Semiconductor devices with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier specially adapted for light emission; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof
- H01L33/02—Semiconductor devices with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier specially adapted for light emission; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by the semiconductor bodies
- H01L33/10—Semiconductor devices with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier specially adapted for light emission; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by the semiconductor bodies with a light reflecting structure, e.g. semiconductor Bragg reflector
- H01L33/105—Semiconductor devices with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier specially adapted for light emission; Processes or apparatus specially adapted for the manufacture or treatment thereof or of parts thereof; Details thereof characterised by the semiconductor bodies with a light reflecting structure, e.g. semiconductor Bragg reflector with a resonant cavity structure
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/02—Structural details or components not essential to laser action
- H01S5/022—Mountings; Housings
- H01S5/0225—Out-coupling of light
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/04—Processes or apparatus for excitation, e.g. pumping, e.g. by electron beams
- H01S5/042—Electrical excitation ; Circuits therefor
- H01S5/0421—Electrical excitation ; Circuits therefor characterised by the semiconducting contacting layers
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/04—Processes or apparatus for excitation, e.g. pumping, e.g. by electron beams
- H01S5/042—Electrical excitation ; Circuits therefor
- H01S5/0421—Electrical excitation ; Circuits therefor characterised by the semiconducting contacting layers
- H01S5/0422—Electrical excitation ; Circuits therefor characterised by the semiconducting contacting layers with n- and p-contacts on the same side of the active layer
- H01S5/0424—Electrical excitation ; Circuits therefor characterised by the semiconducting contacting layers with n- and p-contacts on the same side of the active layer lateral current injection
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/04—Processes or apparatus for excitation, e.g. pumping, e.g. by electron beams
- H01S5/042—Electrical excitation ; Circuits therefor
- H01S5/0425—Electrodes, e.g. characterised by the structure
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/06—Arrangements for controlling the laser output parameters, e.g. by operating on the active medium
- H01S5/062—Arrangements for controlling the laser output parameters, e.g. by operating on the active medium by varying the potential of the electrodes
- H01S5/06203—Transistor-type lasers
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/10—Construction or shape of the optical resonator, e.g. extended or external cavity, coupled cavities, bent-guide, varying width, thickness or composition of the active region
- H01S5/1028—Coupling to elements in the cavity, e.g. coupling to waveguides adjacent the active region, e.g. forward coupled [DFC] structures
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/10—Construction or shape of the optical resonator, e.g. extended or external cavity, coupled cavities, bent-guide, varying width, thickness or composition of the active region
- H01S5/1028—Coupling to elements in the cavity, e.g. coupling to waveguides adjacent the active region, e.g. forward coupled [DFC] structures
- H01S5/1032—Coupling to elements comprising an optical axis that is not aligned with the optical axis of the active region
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/10—Construction or shape of the optical resonator, e.g. extended or external cavity, coupled cavities, bent-guide, varying width, thickness or composition of the active region
- H01S5/1042—Optical microcavities, e.g. cavity dimensions comparable to the wavelength
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/10—Construction or shape of the optical resonator, e.g. extended or external cavity, coupled cavities, bent-guide, varying width, thickness or composition of the active region
- H01S5/1071—Ring-lasers
- H01S5/1075—Disk lasers with special modes, e.g. whispering gallery lasers
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/10—Construction or shape of the optical resonator, e.g. extended or external cavity, coupled cavities, bent-guide, varying width, thickness or composition of the active region
- H01S5/12—Construction or shape of the optical resonator, e.g. extended or external cavity, coupled cavities, bent-guide, varying width, thickness or composition of the active region the resonator having a periodic structure, e.g. in distributed feedback [DFB] lasers
- H01S5/125—Distributed Bragg reflector [DBR] lasers
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/10—Construction or shape of the optical resonator, e.g. extended or external cavity, coupled cavities, bent-guide, varying width, thickness or composition of the active region
- H01S5/18—Surface-emitting [SE] lasers, e.g. having both horizontal and vertical cavities
- H01S5/183—Surface-emitting [SE] lasers, e.g. having both horizontal and vertical cavities having only vertical cavities, e.g. vertical cavity surface-emitting lasers [VCSEL]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/10—Construction or shape of the optical resonator, e.g. extended or external cavity, coupled cavities, bent-guide, varying width, thickness or composition of the active region
- H01S5/18—Surface-emitting [SE] lasers, e.g. having both horizontal and vertical cavities
- H01S5/185—Surface-emitting [SE] lasers, e.g. having both horizontal and vertical cavities having only horizontal cavities, e.g. horizontal cavity surface-emitting lasers [HCSEL]
- H01S5/187—Surface-emitting [SE] lasers, e.g. having both horizontal and vertical cavities having only horizontal cavities, e.g. horizontal cavity surface-emitting lasers [HCSEL] using Bragg reflection
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/20—Structure or shape of the semiconductor body to guide the optical wave ; Confining structures perpendicular to the optical axis, e.g. index or gain guiding, stripe geometry, broad area lasers, gain tailoring, transverse or lateral reflectors, special cladding structures, MQW barrier reflection layers
- H01S5/2004—Confining in the direction perpendicular to the layer structure
- H01S5/2018—Optical confinement, e.g. absorbing-, reflecting- or waveguide-layers
- H01S5/2027—Reflecting region or layer, parallel to the active layer, e.g. to modify propagation of the mode in the laser or to influence transverse modes
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/20—Structure or shape of the semiconductor body to guide the optical wave ; Confining structures perpendicular to the optical axis, e.g. index or gain guiding, stripe geometry, broad area lasers, gain tailoring, transverse or lateral reflectors, special cladding structures, MQW barrier reflection layers
- H01S5/2054—Methods of obtaining the confinement
- H01S5/2059—Methods of obtaining the confinement by means of particular conductivity zones, e.g. obtained by particle bombardment or diffusion
- H01S5/2063—Methods of obtaining the confinement by means of particular conductivity zones, e.g. obtained by particle bombardment or diffusion obtained by particle bombardment
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/30—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region
- H01S5/305—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region characterised by the doping materials used in the laser structure
- H01S5/3054—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region characterised by the doping materials used in the laser structure p-doping
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/30—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region
- H01S5/305—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region characterised by the doping materials used in the laser structure
- H01S5/3086—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region characterised by the doping materials used in the laser structure doping of the active layer
- H01S5/309—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region characterised by the doping materials used in the laser structure doping of the active layer doping of barrier layers that confine charge carriers in the laser structure, e.g. the barriers in a quantum well structure
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/30—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region
- H01S5/34—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region comprising quantum well or superlattice structures, e.g. single quantum well [SQW] lasers, multiple quantum well [MQW] lasers or graded index separate confinement heterostructure [GRINSCH] lasers
- H01S5/343—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region comprising quantum well or superlattice structures, e.g. single quantum well [SQW] lasers, multiple quantum well [MQW] lasers or graded index separate confinement heterostructure [GRINSCH] lasers in AIIIBV compounds, e.g. AlGaAs-laser, InP-based laser
- H01S5/34313—Structure or shape of the active region; Materials used for the active region comprising quantum well or superlattice structures, e.g. single quantum well [SQW] lasers, multiple quantum well [MQW] lasers or graded index separate confinement heterostructure [GRINSCH] lasers in AIIIBV compounds, e.g. AlGaAs-laser, InP-based laser with a well layer having only As as V-compound, e.g. AlGaAs, InGaAs
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L29/00—Semiconductor devices adapted for rectifying, amplifying, oscillating or switching, or capacitors or resistors with at least one potential-jump barrier or surface barrier, e.g. PN junction depletion layer or carrier concentration layer; Details of semiconductor bodies or of electrodes thereof ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/02—Semiconductor bodies ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor
- H01L29/06—Semiconductor bodies ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor characterised by their shape; characterised by the shapes, relative sizes, or dispositions of the semiconductor regions ; characterised by the concentration or distribution of impurities within semiconductor regions
- H01L29/10—Semiconductor bodies ; Multistep manufacturing processes therefor characterised by their shape; characterised by the shapes, relative sizes, or dispositions of the semiconductor regions ; characterised by the concentration or distribution of impurities within semiconductor regions with semiconductor regions connected to an electrode not carrying current to be rectified, amplified or switched and such electrode being part of a semiconductor device which comprises three or more electrodes
- H01L29/1066—Gate region of field-effect devices with PN junction gate
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/04—Processes or apparatus for excitation, e.g. pumping, e.g. by electron beams
- H01S5/042—Electrical excitation ; Circuits therefor
- H01S5/0425—Electrodes, e.g. characterised by the structure
- H01S5/04256—Electrodes, e.g. characterised by the structure characterised by the configuration
- H01S5/04257—Electrodes, e.g. characterised by the structure characterised by the configuration having positive and negative electrodes on the same side of the substrate
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/06—Arrangements for controlling the laser output parameters, e.g. by operating on the active medium
- H01S5/062—Arrangements for controlling the laser output parameters, e.g. by operating on the active medium by varying the potential of the electrodes
- H01S5/06226—Modulation at ultra-high frequencies
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/06—Arrangements for controlling the laser output parameters, e.g. by operating on the active medium
- H01S5/062—Arrangements for controlling the laser output parameters, e.g. by operating on the active medium by varying the potential of the electrodes
- H01S5/0625—Arrangements for controlling the laser output parameters, e.g. by operating on the active medium by varying the potential of the electrodes in multi-section lasers
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/20—Structure or shape of the semiconductor body to guide the optical wave ; Confining structures perpendicular to the optical axis, e.g. index or gain guiding, stripe geometry, broad area lasers, gain tailoring, transverse or lateral reflectors, special cladding structures, MQW barrier reflection layers
- H01S5/2054—Methods of obtaining the confinement
- H01S5/2081—Methods of obtaining the confinement using special etching techniques
- H01S5/2086—Methods of obtaining the confinement using special etching techniques lateral etch control, e.g. mask induced
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01S—DEVICES USING THE PROCESS OF LIGHT AMPLIFICATION BY STIMULATED EMISSION OF RADIATION [LASER] TO AMPLIFY OR GENERATE LIGHT; DEVICES USING STIMULATED EMISSION OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION IN WAVE RANGES OTHER THAN OPTICAL
- H01S5/00—Semiconductor lasers
- H01S5/20—Structure or shape of the semiconductor body to guide the optical wave ; Confining structures perpendicular to the optical axis, e.g. index or gain guiding, stripe geometry, broad area lasers, gain tailoring, transverse or lateral reflectors, special cladding structures, MQW barrier reflection layers
- H01S5/22—Structure or shape of the semiconductor body to guide the optical wave ; Confining structures perpendicular to the optical axis, e.g. index or gain guiding, stripe geometry, broad area lasers, gain tailoring, transverse or lateral reflectors, special cladding structures, MQW barrier reflection layers having a ridge or stripe structure
- H01S5/2205—Structure or shape of the semiconductor body to guide the optical wave ; Confining structures perpendicular to the optical axis, e.g. index or gain guiding, stripe geometry, broad area lasers, gain tailoring, transverse or lateral reflectors, special cladding structures, MQW barrier reflection layers having a ridge or stripe structure comprising special burying or current confinement layers
- H01S5/2218—Structure or shape of the semiconductor body to guide the optical wave ; Confining structures perpendicular to the optical axis, e.g. index or gain guiding, stripe geometry, broad area lasers, gain tailoring, transverse or lateral reflectors, special cladding structures, MQW barrier reflection layers having a ridge or stripe structure comprising special burying or current confinement layers having special optical properties
- H01S5/222—Structure or shape of the semiconductor body to guide the optical wave ; Confining structures perpendicular to the optical axis, e.g. index or gain guiding, stripe geometry, broad area lasers, gain tailoring, transverse or lateral reflectors, special cladding structures, MQW barrier reflection layers having a ridge or stripe structure comprising special burying or current confinement layers having special optical properties having a refractive index lower than that of the cladding layers or outer guiding layers
Definitions
- the present application relates to semiconductor integrated circuits that implement a variety optoelectronic functions (such as optical emitters, optical detectors and optical switches) and electronic functions (such as heterojunction field effect transistors and bipolar field effect transistors).
- optoelectronic functions such as optical emitters, optical detectors and optical switches
- electronic functions such as heterojunction field effect transistors and bipolar field effect transistors.
- POET Planar Optoelectronic Technology
- devices opticalelectronic devices, logic circuits and/or signal processing circuits
- inversion quantum-well channel device structures as described in detail in U.S. Pat. No. 6,031,243; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/556,285, filed on Apr. 24, 2000; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/798,316, filed on Mar. 2, 2001; International Application No. PCT/US02/06802 filed on Mar. 4, 2002; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 08/949,504, filed on Oct. 14, 1997, U.S. patent application Ser. No.
- n type and p type contacts, critical etches, etc. can be used to realize all of these devices simultaneously on a common substrate.
- the essential features of this device structure include 1) an n-type modulation doped interface and a p-type modulation doped quantum well interface, 2) self-aligned n-type and p-type channel contacts formed by ion implantation, 3) n-type metal contacts to the n-type ion implants and the bottom n-type layer structure, and 4) p-type metal contacts to the p-type ion implants and the top p-type layer structure.
- the active device structures are preferably realized with a material system of group III-V materials (such as a GaAs/AlGaAs).
- POET can be used to construct a variety of optoelectronic devices. POET can also be used to construct a variety of high performance transistor devices, such as complementary NHFET and PHFET unipolar devices as well as n-type and p-type HBT bipolar devices.
- a semiconductor device employs an epitaxial layer arrangement including a first ohmic contact layer and first modulation doped quantum well structure disposed above the first ohmic contact layer.
- the first ohmic contact layer has a first doping type
- the first modulation doped quantum well structure has a modulation doped layer of a second doping type.
- At least one isolation ion implant region is provided that extends through the first ohmic contact layer.
- the at least one isolation ion implant region can include oxygen ions.
- the at least one isolation ion implant region can define a region that is substantially free of charge carriers in order to reduce a characteristic capacitance of the device.
- the epitaxial layer arrangement further includes at least one spacer layer disposed above the first modulation doped quantum well structure.
- a mesa can be formed in the at least one spacer layer.
- At least one contact implant region can be disposed below the mesa in contact with the first modulation doped quantum well structure.
- At least one electrode terminal can be formed on the mesa in contact with the at least one contact implant region.
- the at least one isolation implant region can be disposed below the mesa and below the at least one contact implant region.
- the first modulation doped quantum well structure defines a QW channel of an HFET device, wherein the QW channel extends between opposed contact ion implant regions that are in contact with corresponding source and drain terminal electrodes of the HFET device, and a gate terminal electrode of the HFET device is in contact with the first ohmic contact layer.
- the first modulation doped quantum well structure defines a QW channel of a BICFET device, wherein the QW channel is in contact with a base terminal electrode of the BICFET device, and an emitter terminal electrode of the BICFET device is in contact with the first ohmic contact layer.
- the at least one isolation implant region provides for lateral confinement of light within a resonant cavity defined by the epitaxial layer arrangement.
- the first modulation doped quantum well structure, the first ohmic contact layer and the at least one isolation implant region are all part of an optical resonator formed in the epitaxial layer arrangement, wherein the optical resonator is adapted to process light at at least one predetermined wavelength.
- the optical resonator can include a resonant cavity supporting propagation of an optical signal therein, wherein the at least one isolation implant is disposed adjacent the resonant cavity.
- a first terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the first modulation doped quantum well structure.
- a second terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the first ohmic contact layer.
- the first and second terminal electrodes can be configured as terminals of a diode laser whereby injected electrical current flows between the first and second terminal electrodes and causes light generation and propagation within the resonant cavity.
- the first and second terminal electrodes are configured as terminals of a diode optical detector that carry electrical current caused by absorption of light propagating within the resonant cavity.
- the epitaxial layer arrangement can include at least one spacer layer disposed above the first modulation doped quantum well structure, a second modulation doped quantum well structure disposed above the at least one spacer layer, and a second ohmic contact layer disposed above the second modulation doped quantum well structure.
- the second modulation doped quantum well structure has a modulation doped layer of the first doping type, and the second ohmic contact layer has the second doping type.
- a top terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the second ohmic contact layer.
- a first injector terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the second modulation doped quantum well structure.
- a second injector terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the first modulation doped quantum well structure.
- a bottom terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the first ohmic contact layer.
- the top terminal electrode, the first injector terminal electrode, the second injector terminal electrode, and the bottom teitninal electrode can be configured as terminals of a switching thyristor laser having an ON state whereby current flows between the top terminal electrode and bottom terminal electrode to cause light generation and propagation within the resonant cavity.
- the top terminal electrode, the first injector terminal electrode, the second injector terminal electrode, and the bottom terminal electrode can be configured as terminals of a switching thyristor optical detector having an ON state whereby current flows between the top terminal electrode and bottom terminal electrode, wherein the ON state is caused by absorption of light propagation in the resonant cavity.
- the resonant cavity can have a disk-like shape and the optical signal comprises a whispering gallery optical signal, or the resonant cavity can have an annular-shape and the optical signal comprises a circulating optical signal.
- the at least one isolation implant region can be disposed adjacent a central region of the resonant cavity or adjacent a peripheral region of the resonant cavity.
- the resonant cavity can be defined by a rib waveguide, wherein the at least one isolation implant region is disposed on at least one side of the rib waveguide.
- the rib waveguide can have a plurality of straight sections that are optically coupled together by bend sections.
- a coupling waveguide structure can be spaced from the resonant cavity of optical resonator to provide for evanescent-wave optical coupling therebetween.
- the resonant cavity of the optical resonator and the coupling waveguide structure can be defined by sidewalls of the epitaxial layer arrangement.
- the epitaxial layer arrangement can be disposed above a bottom DBR mirror, wherein the sidewalls that define the resonant cavity of the optical resonator and the coupling waveguide structure extend downward to the bottom DBR mirror.
- the epitaxial layer arrangement includes an N+ type doped layer for the first ohmic contact layer, a first plurality of layers that define a p-type modulation doped quantum well structure for the first modulation doped quantum well structure, a second plurality of layers that define an n-type modulation doped quantum well structure for the second n-type modulation doped structure, and a P+ type doped layer for the second ohmic contact layer.
- a semiconductor device in another aspect, includes a dual-cavity optical resonator having a first vertical resonant cavity surrounded by a second annular resonant cavity formed in an epitaxial layer arrangement.
- a coupling waveguide structure is spaced from the second resonant cavity of optical resonator to provide for evanescent-wave optical coupling therebetween.
- the second resonant cavity of the optical resonator and the coupling waveguide structure can be defined by sidewalls of the epitaxial layer arrangement.
- the coupling waveguide structure and the optical resonator can be configured to perform predetermined mode transformation operations selected from the group consisting of vertical propagation to in-plane propagation, in-plane propagation to vertical propagation, wavelength conversion, and combinations thereof.
- the epitaxial layer arrangement includes a first ohmic contact layer, a first modulation doped quantum well structure disposed above the first ohmic contact layer, at least one spacer layer disposed above the first modulation doped quantum well structure, a second modulation doped quantum well structure disposed above the spacer layer, and a second ohmic contact layer disposed above the second modulation doped quantum well structure, wherein the first ohmic contact layer has a first doping type, the first modulation doped quantum well structure has a modulation doped layer of a second doping type, the second first modulation doped quantum well structure has a modulation doped layer of the first doping type, and the second ohmic contact layer has the second doping type.
- the dual cavity resonator can include a top terminal electrode in electrical contact with the second ohmic contact layer, at least one of a first injector terminal electrode s (which is in electrical contact with the second modulation doped quantum well structure) and a second injector terminal (which is in electrical contact with the first modulation doped quantum well structure), and a bottom terminal electrode in electrical contact with the first ohmic contact layer.
- the electrodes of the device can be configured as terminals of a switching thyristor laser having an ON state whereby current flows between the top terminal electrode and bottom terminal electrode causes light generation and propagation within the vertical resonant cavity.
- the electrodes of the device are configured as terminals of a switching thyristor optical detector having an ON state whereby current flows between the top terminal electrode and bottom terminal electrode, wherein the ON state is caused by absorption of light propagating in the vertical resonant cavity.
- a semiconductor device in yet another aspect, includes an optical resonator including a closed path waveguide that supports circulating propagation of light.
- a waveguide structure is spaced from the closed path waveguide of the optical resonator to provide for evanescent-wave optical coupling therebetween.
- the closed path waveguide includes at least one active section and a tuning section that is isolated from the at least one active section.
- the active section is configured to generate or absorb light that circulates in the closed path waveguide.
- the tuning section is configured to provide electrical control of the wavelength of the light circulating in the closed path waveguide.
- the closed path waveguide of the optical resonator and the waveguide structure can both be formed in an epitaxial layer structure that includes at least one modulation doped quantum well structure.
- the tuning section of the closed path waveguide can include a plurality of electrodes for supplying electrical signals that control charge in one or more quantum wells of the at least one modulation doped quantum well structure of the tuning section in order to control the wavelength of the light circulating in the closed path waveguide.
- the tuning section of the closed path waveguide can be isolated from the at least one active section by passive waveguide sections.
- a semiconductor device in yet another aspect, includes an optical resonator having a closed path waveguide that supports circulating propagation of light.
- a waveguide structure is spaced from the closed path waveguide of the optical resonator to provide for evanescent-wave optical coupling therebetween.
- the waveguide structure has a first end disposed opposite a second end.
- a reflector structure is integral to the first end of the waveguide structure.
- the reflector structure includes a Bragg-grating that is configured to reflect a particular wavelength of light.
- the reflector structure can include two co-planar radio-frequency (RF) traveling wave transmission lines disposed on opposite sides of the Bragg-grating along the length of the Bragg-grating.
- RF radio-frequency
- a signal source can be configured to supply a traveling wave RF signal to the two co-planar RF traveling wave transmission lines in order to selectively vary the particular wavelength of light that is reflected by the Bragg-grating of the reflector structure.
- the closed path waveguide of the optical resonator and the waveguide structure and the reflector structure can all be formed in an epitaxial layer structure that includes at least one layer disposed above a modulation doped quantum well structure,
- the Bragg-grating can be formed in the at least one layer disposed above the modulation doped quantum well structure.
- a method for forming a patterned layer of metal that defines an aperture of an optoelectronic device that is part of integrated circuit wafer.
- the method includes depositing and patterning a first mask on a top surface of the wafer, wherein the pattern of the first mask defines a feature that protects an area of the aperture.
- An ion implant operation is performed that forms at least one implant region adjacent the aperture.
- Metal is deposited such that the metal covers the top surface and the mask feature.
- a second mask is deposited and patterned to define a window that overlies the mask feature. The window has a smaller width that width of the mask feature.
- a first etch operation is performed that etches through the window defined by the second mask to a depth at or near the top surface.
- the first etch operation leaves being at least one sidewall of the mask feature.
- a second etch operation is performed that etches sideways and undercuts the at least one opposed sidewall of the mask feature as well as at least one adjacent sidewall of the metal to form the aperture.
- the first mask can be a dual layer structure of oxide and nitride.
- the second mask can be a photoresist material.
- the at least one ion implant region can provide for current funneling toward an active region under the aperture and/or lateral confinement of light within the active region under the aperture.
- the metal comprises tungsten.
- the sidewall(s) that result from the first etch operation can have a width dimension on the order of 1-2 ⁇ m.
- the first etch operation can employ an anisotropic etching process that define a near vertical profile for the sidewall(s).
- the second etch operation can employ a buffer-oxide etchant.
- an optoelectronic semiconductor device in another aspect, includes a substrate and an epitaxial layer arrangement formed on the substrate.
- the epitaxial layer arrangement includes a buffer structure and an active device structure formed on the buffer structure.
- the active device structure includes at least one modulation doped quantum well structure spaced from a QD-in-QW structure.
- the buffer structure comprises a plurality of layer that are configured to accommodate lattice strain due to mismatch between the active device structure and the substrate.
- the substrate is a GaAs substrate
- the at least one modulation doped quantum well structure includes at least one InGaAs quantum well formed from an alloy of InAs and GaAs that includes at least 70 percent InAs
- the QD-in-QW structure includes quantum dots formed from InAs and embedded within at least one InGaAs quantum well formed from an alloy of InAs and GaAs that includes at least 70 percent InAs.
- the InGaAs quantum well of the QD-in-QW structure can include a template substructure formed below an emission substructure.
- the template substructure includes a non-graded InGaAs quantum well formed from an alloy of InAs and GaAs that includes less than 70 percent InAs
- the emission substructure includes a graded InGaAs quantum well formed from an alloy of InAs and GaAs that has a maximum percentage of InAs of at least 70 percent InAs.
- the buffer structure can include a plurality of layers formed from an alloy of InAs and AlAs and possibly a periodic superlattice layer structure comprising a first layer formed from an alloy of AlAs and GaAs and a second layer formed from GaAs.
- a method of fabricating an optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit wafer that includes a top layer overlying a doped ohmic contact layer and semiconductor layers therebelow.
- the method includes depositing a protective layer on the top layer, and depositing and patterning a first mask on the protective layer, wherein the pattern of the first mask protects an area for an optical feature.
- a first etch operation is performed that etches down to the doped ohmic contact in order to define the optical feature that includes the top layer.
- the first etch operation exposes the doped ohmic contact layer on at least one side of the optical feature and leaves behind at least one sidewall of the optical feature.
- An ion implant operation is performed that forms at least one ion implant region in the semiconductor layers disposed below the exposed doped ohmic contact layer and adjacent the at least one side of the optical feature.
- a second mask is deposited and patterned to define a window that overlies the optical feature.
- a second etch operation is performed that uses the window of the second mask to expose the top layer of the optical feature.
- the optical feature is selected from group consisting of an aperture, a waveguide layer of an active waveguide structure, and a waveguide layer of a passive waveguide structure.
- the method can further include depositing metal such that the metal covers the optical feature.
- the second mask is deposited on the metal and the window defined by the second mask exposes metal that covers the optical feature, and the second etch operation removes the metal that covers the optical feature in order to expose the top layer of the optical feature.
- the optical feature is selected from group consisting of an aperture, a waveguide layer of an active waveguide structure, and a waveguide layer of a passive waveguide structure.
- the top layer can comprise an undoped semiconductor layer.
- the protective layer can comprise a silicon nitride layer.
- the first etch operation can employ an anisotropic etching process that define a near vertical profile for the at least one sidewall of the optical feature.
- the second etch operation can employ a buffer-oxide etchant.
- FIG. 1 is a schematic illustration of exemplary layer structures of the optoelectronic integrated circuit device structures of FIGS. 2A to 9D .
- FIGS. 2A-2B illustrate a diode whispering gallery microresonator realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 ;
- FIG. 2A is a schematic top view of the diode whispering gallery microresonator.
- FIG. 2B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the diode thyristor whispering gallery microresonator along the section labeled 2 B- 2 B of FIG. 2A .
- FIG. 3A-3B illustrate a diode ring microresonator realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 ;
- FIG. 3A is a schematic top view of the diode ring microresonator; and
- FIG. 3B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the diode ring microresonator along the section labeled 3 B- 3 B of FIG. 3A .
- FIGS. 4A-4B illustrate a thyristor whispering gallery microresonator realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 ;
- FIG. 4A is a schematic top view of the thyristor whispering gallery microresonator;
- FIG. 4B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the thyristor whispering gallery microresonator along the section labeled 4 B- 4 B of FIG. 4A .
- FIGS. 5A-5E illustrates an embodiment of a closed-loop (rectangular path) microresonator realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 ;
- FIG. 5A is a schematic top view of the closed-loop microresonator;
- FIG. 5B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the closed-loop microresonator along the section labeled 5 B- 5 B of FIG. 5A ;
- FIG. 5C is a schematic cross-sectional view of the closed-loop microresonator along the section labeled 5 C- 5 C of FIG. 5A ;
- FIG. 5A is a schematic top view of the closed-loop microresonator;
- FIG. 5B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the closed-loop microresonator along the section labeled 5 B- 5 B of FIG. 5A ;
- FIG. 5C is a schematic cross-sectional view of the closed-loop microresonator along
- FIG. 5D is a schematic cross-sectional view of the closed-loop microresonator along the section labeled 5 D- 5 D of FIG. 5A ; and FIG. 5E is a schematic cross-sectional view of the closed-loop microresonator along the section labeled 5 E- 5 E of FIG. 5A .
- FIGS. 5F-5H illustrates an embodiment of a closed-loop (rectangular path) microresonator and electrically-controlled tuning reflector that are realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 ;
- FIG. 5F is a schematic top view of the closed-loop microresonator and electrically-controlled tuning reflector;
- FIG. 5G is a schematic cross-sectional view of the tuning reflector along the section labeled 5 G- 5 GB of FIG. 5F ;
- FIG. 5H is a cross-section through the tuning reflector along the section labeled 5 H- 5 H of FIG. 5F .
- FIGS. 6A-6C illustrate an embodiment of a split-electrode vertical cavity surface emitting device realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 ;
- FIG. 6A is a schematic top view of the split-electrode vertical cavity surface emitting device;
- FIG. 6B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the split-electrode vertical cavity surface emitting device along the section labeled 6 B- 6 B of FIG. 6A ;
- FIG. 6C is a schematic cross-sectional view of the split-electrode vertical cavity surface emitting device along the section labeled 6 C- 6 C of FIG. 6A .
- FIGS. 7A to 7C illustrate an embodiment of a p-channel HFET device realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 ;
- FIG. 7A is a schematic top view of the p-channel HFET device;
- FIG. 7B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the p-channel HFET device along the section labeled 7 B- 7 B of FIG. 7A ;
- FIG. 7C is a schematic cross-sectional view of the p-channel HFET device along the section labeled 7 C- 7 C of FIG. 7A .
- FIGS. 8A to 8C illustrates a dual-wavelength hybrid device realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 ;
- FIG. 8A is a schematic top view of the dual-wavelength hybrid device;
- FIG. 8B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the dual-wavelength hybrid device along the section labeled 8 B- 8 B of FIG. 8A ;
- FIG. 8C is a schematic cross-sectional view of the dual-wavelength hybrid device along the section labeled 8 C- 8 C of FIG. 8A .
- FIGS. 9A to 9D illustrate exemplary fabrication steps that form dopant implant regions that are self-aligned to patterned metal as part of an optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit wafer that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- FIG. 10 is a schematic illustration of another exemplary layer structure for realizing the optoelectronic integrated circuit device structures described herein.
- FIGS. 11A to 11F collectively, are a chart illustrating an exemplary layer structure for realizing the optoelectronic integrated circuit device structures described herein.
- FIGS. 12A to 12I illustrate exemplary fabrication steps that form an aperture (or in-plane waveguide) in conjunction with patterned metal electrodes and/or aligned implant regions as part of an optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 10 .
- the device structure of the present application includes a bottom dielectric distributed Bragg reflector (DBR) mirror 12 formed on substrate 10 .
- the bottom DBR mirror 12 is typically formed by depositing pairs of semiconductor or dielectric materials with different refractive indices. When two materials with different refractive indices are placed together to form a junction, light will be reflected at the junction. The amount of light reflected at one such boundary is small. However, if multiple junctions/layer pairs are stacked periodically with each layer having a quarter-wave ( ⁇ /4) optical thickness, the reflections from each of the boundaries will be added in phase to produce a large amount of reflected light (e.g., a large reflection coefficient) at the particular center wavelength ⁇ C .
- ⁇ C quarter-wave
- the active device structure suitable for realizing complementary heterostructure field-effect transistor (HFET) devices is the active device structure suitable for realizing complementary heterostructure field-effect transistor (HFET) devices.
- the first of these complementary HFET devices is a p-channel HFET which has a p-type modulation doped quantum well (QW) structure 20 with an n-type gate region (i.e., n-type ohmic contact layer 14 and n-type layer(s) 16 )) below the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- An undoped spacer layer 18 is disposed between the p-type modulation doped quantum well (QW) structure 20 and the underlying n-type layer(s) 16 .
- the spacer layers 22 are disposed above the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- the spacer layers 22 can include a first QD-In-QW structure (not shown) formed above the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 , where the first QD-In-QW structure includes at least one QW layer with self-assembled quantum dots (QDs) embedded therein.
- the first QD-In-QW structure can be spaced from the QW(s) of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 by an undoped spacer layer therebetween.
- the second of these complementary HFET devices is an n-channel HFET which includes an n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 with a p-type gate region (i.e., p-type layer(s) 28 and p-type ohmic contact 30 ) formed above the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 .
- An undoped spacer layer 26 is disposed between the n-type modulation doped quantum well (QW) structure 24 and the overlying p-type layer(s) 28 .
- the spacer layers 22 can also include a second QD-In-QW structure (not shown) formed below the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 , where the second QD-In-QW structure includes at least one QW layer with self-assembled quantum dots (QDs) embedded therein.
- the second QD-In-QW structure can be spaced from the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 by an undoped spacer layer therebetween.
- the layers encompassing the spacer layer 22 and the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 forms the collector region of the p-channel HFET.
- the layers encompassing the spacer layer 22 and the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 forms the collector region of the n-channel HFET.
- collector regions are analogous to the substrate region of a MOSFET device as is well known. Therefore a non-inverted n-channel HFET device is stacked upon an inverted p-channel HFET device as part of the active device structure.
- the active device layer structure begins with n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 which enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto.
- Deposited on layer 14 are one or more n-type layers 16 and an undoped spacer layer 18 which serve electrically as part of the gate of the p-channel HFET device and optically as a part of the lower waveguide cladding of the device.
- Deposited on layer 18 is the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 that defines a p-type charge sheet offset from one or more QWs (which may be formed from strained or unstrained heterojunction materials) by an undoped spacer layer.
- the p-type charge sheet is formed first below the undoped spacer and the one or more QWs of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 . All of the layers grown thus far form the p-channel HFET device with the gate ohmic contact on the bottom.
- Deposited on the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 is one or more spacer layers 22 .
- the spacer layers 22 can include first and QD-In-QW structures (not shown) that correspond to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 and the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 , respectively, and are offset from the corresponding structure by a respective undoped spacer layer.
- the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 defines an n-type charge sheet offset from one or more QWs by an undoped spacer layer. The n-type charge sheet is formed last above the undoped spacer and the one or more QWs of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 .
- the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 Deposited on the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 is an undoped spacer layer 26 and one or more p-type layers 28 which can serve electrically as part of the gate of the n-channel HFET and optically as part of the upper waveguide cladding of the device.
- the p-type layers 28 include two sheets of planar doping of highly doped p-material separated by a lightly doped layer of p-material. These p-type layers are offset from the n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 24 by the undoped spacer layer 26 .
- the top charge sheet achieves low gate contact resistance and the bottom charge sheet defines the capacitance of the n-channel HFET with respect to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 .
- Deposited on p-type layer(s) 28 is one or more p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30 , which enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto.
- a gate terminal electrode (not shown) of the n-channel HFET device is operably coupled to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30 .
- a source terminal electrode (not shown) and a drain terminal electrode (not shown) of the n-channel HFET device are operably coupled to opposite ends of a QW channel(s) realized in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 .
- One or more terminal electrodes (not shown) can be operably coupled to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 and used as collector terminal electrodes for the n-channel HFET device.
- FIGS. 7A-7C An exemplary embodiment of the p-channel HFET device is shown in FIGS. 7A-7C , which includes a gate terminal electrode (G), a source terminal electrode (S), a drain terminal electrode (D), and a collector terminal electrode (Coll).
- the source terminal electrode (S) and the drain terminal electrode (D) are operably coupled to opposite sides of an elongate QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- the layer structure of the p-channel HFET device is patterned and etched down to spacer layer 22 to form a top mesa 711 at spacer layer 22 for the collector electrode (Coll).
- the resulting structure is then patterned and etched to form opposed elongate mesas 713 , 715 in the spacer layer 22 above the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- the elongate mesas 713 , 715 are disposed on opposite sides of the elongate collector terminal electrode (Coll) along the lengthwise dimension of the collector terminal electrode (Coll) as best shown in FIGS. 7A and 7B .
- a sequence of two different ion implant operations is then carried out to implant ions through the elongate mesas 713 , 715 .
- the first implant operation employs p-type acceptor ions, such as beryllium ions, to form p-type ion implant regions 719 that create the self-aligned p-type contacts to the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 that forms the QW channel of the p-channel HFET device.
- This implant can also possibly be accompanied by an implant of fluorine ions to prevent upward diffusion.
- a rapid thermal anneal (RTA) oxide is then deposited on the resultant structure and RTA operations are carried (for example, at 850° C. for 10 seconds) to activate the implant regions 719 .
- a second implant operation is carried out involving oxygen ions to form high resistance deep oxygen ion implant regions 721 in the bottom n+ contact layer 14 , where such high resistance effectively blocks current flow therethrough.
- the peak density of the oxygen ion implant regions 721 can be controlled to provide the desired resistance. In one embodiment, the peak density of the oxygen ion implant regions 721 is at or near 1e 19 cm-3. Multiple implants of oxygen ions at different energies can be used to provide complete coverage of the thickness of the bottom n+ contact layer 14 .
- An RTA is then performed (preferably at 500° C. for about 15 seconds) in order to activate the oxygen ion implant regions 721 .
- implant regions 719 and 721 are stacked on top another under both the source mesa 713 and the drain mesa 715 as best shown in FIG. 7B and extend parallel to the QW channel under the collector terminal electrode (Coll) along the lengthwise dimension of the QW channel on opposite sides of the QW channel.
- the current blocking oxygen ion implant regions 721 define an isolation region between the p-type implant regions 719 and the bottom N+-type ohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure.
- Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the source terminal electrode (S) and the gate terminal electrode (G). This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the PHFET device if not reduced.
- the temperature (e.g., 500° C.) of the rapid thermal anneal operation that activates the oxygen ions of the implant regions 721 can be significantly less than the temperature (e.g., 850° C.) of the rapid thermal anneal operation that activates the ions of the implant regions 719 .
- the resulting structure is then etched to form a mesa 723 at the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 for the gate terminal electrode (G) as best shown in FIG. 7C .
- the metal of the collector terminal electrode (Coll) can have a wide tab-region 709 offset laterally from the source and drain terminal electrodes as best shown in FIG. 7A .
- the resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the source, drain and gate electrodes as desired. In one embodiment, the resultant structure can be heated at 420° C. to treat the metal alloys of the source, drain, gate and collector electrodes of the device.
- Both the n-channel HFET device and the p-channel HFET device are field effect transistors where current flows as a two-dimensional gas through a QW channel with contacts at either end.
- the basic transistor action is the modulation of the QW channel conductance by a modulated electric field that is perpendicular to the QW channel.
- the modulated electric field modulates the QW channel conductance by controlling an inversion layer (i.e., a two-dimensional electron gas for the n-channel HFET device or a two-dimensional hole gas for the p-channel HFET) as a function of gate voltage relative to source voltage.
- the QW channel conductance is turned on by biasing the gate terminal electrode and the source terminal electrode at voltages where the P/N junction of the gate and source regions is forward biased with minimal gate conduction and an inversion layer of electron gas is created in the QW channel of the n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 24 between the source terminal electrode and the drain terminal electrode.
- the source terminal electrode is the terminal electrode from which the electron carriers enter the QW channel of the n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 24
- the drain terminal electrode is the terminal electrode where the electron carriers leave the device
- the gate terminal electrode is the control terminal for the device.
- the p-channel HFET device of FIGS. 7A-7C operates in a similar manner to the n-channel HFET device with the current direction and voltage polarities reversed with respect to those of the n-channel HFET device.
- the QW channel conductance is turned on by biasing the gate terminal electrode (G) and the source terminal electrode (S) at a voltage where the P/N junction of the source and gate regions is forward-biased with minimal gate conduction and an inversion layer of hole gas is created in the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 between the source terminal electrode (S) and the drain terminal electrode (S).
- the source terminal electrode (S) is the terminal from which the hole carriers enter the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20
- the drain terminal electrode (D) is the terminal where the hole carriers leave the device
- the gate terminal electrode (G) is the control terminal for the device.
- the device structure of the present application can also be configured to realize bipolar inversion channel field-effect transistors (BICFETs) with either an n-type modulation doped quantum well inversion channel base region (n-channel base BICFET) or a p-type modulation doped quantum well inversion channel base region (p-channel base BICFET).
- BICFETs bipolar inversion channel field-effect transistors
- an emitter terminal electrode (not shown) of the n-channel base BICFET device is operably coupled to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30 of the active device structure.
- a base terminal electrode (not shown) of the n-channel base BICFET device is operably coupled to the QW channel(s) realized in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 .
- a collector terminal electrode (not shown) of the n-channel base BICFET device is operably coupled to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- the n-channel base BICFET device is a bipolar junction type transistor which can be operated in an active mode by applying a forward bias to the PN junction of the emitter and base regions while applying a reverse bias to the PN junction of the base and collector regions, which causes holes to be injected from the emitter terminal electrode to the collector terminal electrode. Because the holes are positive carriers, their injection contributes to current flowing out of the collector terminal electrode as well as current flowing into the emitter terminal electrode. The bias conditions also cause electrons to be injected from the base to the emitter, which contributes to current flowing out of the base terminal electrode as well as the current flowing into the emitter terminal electrode.
- the p-channel base BICFET device is similar in construction to the p-channel HFET device of FIGS. 7A-7C with the following adaptations.
- An emitter terminal electrode of the p-channel base BICFET device which is analogous to the gate terminal electrode of the p-channel HFET device, is operably coupled to the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 of the active device structure.
- a base terminal electrode of the p-channel base BICFET device which is analogous to the source or drain electrode of the p-channel HFET device, is operably coupled to the QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- a collector terminal electrode of the p-channel base BICFET device which is analogous to the collector terminal electrode of the p-channel HFET device, is operably coupled to the spacer layer 22 .
- the p-channel base BICFET device is a bipolar junction type transistor which can be operated in an active mode by applying a forward bias to the PN junction of the emitter and base regions while applying a reverse bias to the PN junction of the base and collector regions, which causes electrons to be injected from the emitter terminal electrode to the collector terminal electrode. Because the electrons are negative carriers, their injection contributes to current flowing into the collector terminal electrode as well as current flowing out of the emitter terminal electrode.
- the bias conditions also cause holes to be injected from the base to the emitter, which contributes to current flowing into the base terminal electrode as well as the current flowing out of the emitter terminal electrode.
- the device structure of the present application can also be configured to realize optoelectronic devices such as an electrically-pumped laser or optical detector.
- optoelectronic devices such as an electrically-pumped laser or optical detector.
- a top mirror can be formed over the active device structure described above.
- the top mirror can be formed by depositing pairs of semiconductor or dielectric materials with different refractive indices.
- the resonant cavity of the device can be configured as a vertical cavity and light may enter and exit the vertical cavity through an optical aperture (not shown) in the top surface of the device such that the device operates as a vertical cavity surface emitting laser/detector.
- the distance between the top mirror and the bottom DBR mirror 12 represents the length of the optical cavity and can be set to correspond to the designated wavelength (such as 1 to 3 times the designated wavelength). This distance can take into account the penetration depth of the light into the bottom and top mirror. This distance is controlled by adjusting the thickness of one or more of the layers therebetween to enable this condition.
- the resonant cavity of the device can be configured as a whispering gallery or closed-loop microresonator to support propagation of an optical mode signal within a waveguide region formed from the device structure.
- the waveguide region can be a disk-like structure that supports propagation of a whispering gallery mode.
- the geometry of the disk-like structure is tuned to the particular wavelength of the whispering gallery mode.
- the circumference of the disk-like structure can be configured to correspond to an integral number of wavelengths of a standing wave that circulates in the disk-like structure.
- the free spectral range FSR is large enough such that the diameter of the disk-like structure can dictate the particular wavelength of the whispering gallery mode.
- the waveguide can support circulating propagation of an optical mode that follows a circular optical path, a rectangular optical path, an oval optical path, or other suitable geometry.
- the optical path length of the closed-loop waveguide is tuned to the particular wavelength of the optical mode signal that is to propagate in the closed-loop waveguide.
- At least one coupling waveguide is formed integral to and adjacent the whispering gallery or closed-loop microresonator.
- the coupling waveguide provides for evanescent coupling of light to and/or from the whispering gallery or closed-loop microresonator.
- the whispering gallery mode produced by the whispering gallery microresonator or the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator is coupled to the coupling waveguide to produce an output optical signal that propagates in the coupling waveguide for output therefrom.
- an input optical light is supplied to the coupling waveguide, which couples the input optical light as a whispering gallery mode in the whispering gallery microresonator for detection or as an optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator for detection.
- an anode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30
- a cathode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 .
- One or more optional electrodes can be operably coupled to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 as well as to the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 . If present, these optional electrodes are configured to float electrically with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode.
- the p-type region of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode. Electrically, this configuration operates as an electrically-pumped diode laser or diode detector. This configuration is referred to herein as the top diode laser or top diode detector because the anode terminal electrode is operably coupled to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30 and the cathode terminal electrode is operably coupled to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 .
- the anode terminal electrode is forward biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode such that holes are injected from the anode terminal electrode into the QW channel(s) realized in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 in order to induce photon emission within the device structure.
- the lower p-type region of the active device structure (which includes the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode.
- the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode that is emitted vertically through the top surface of the device structure.
- the photon emission within the device structure produces the whispering gallery mode signal that circulates in the waveguide of the whispering gallery microresonator.
- the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator.
- the top diode laser operates by injecting electrons into the QW channel of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 , which lowers the barrier of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 and allows holes to flow over this barrier to the QW of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 supplies electrons by diffusion to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 . That means there will also be electrons and holes in the lower p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 and therefore recombination and stimulated emission.
- the lower p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 is not a loss mechanism but instead can contribute to the laser output even though there is no electrical contact to the lower QW structure.
- the laser contribution of the lower p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 may be somewhat less than the upper n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 . It is also noted that in order for this process to work, the lower p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 must be allowed to float in potential so to allow the carrier diffusion mechanisms to operate as described above.
- the anode terminal electrode is reversed biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode.
- the lower p-type region of the active device structure (which includes the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode.
- the reverse bias conditions are selected such that the device produces photocurrent proportional to the intensity of an optical signal absorbed by the device structure.
- the device structure absorbs the optical mode that is received vertically through the top surface of the device structure.
- the whispering gallery microresonator the device structure absorbs the whispering gallery mode that propagates in the waveguide of the whispering gallery microresonator.
- the closed-loop microresonator the device structure absorbs the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator.
- an anode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20
- a cathode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14
- One or more optional electrodes can be operably coupled to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 as well as to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30 . If present, these optional electrodes are configured to float electrically with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode.
- the n-type region of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode. Electrically, this configuration operates as an electrically-pumped diode laser or diode detector. This configuration is referred to herein as the bottom diode laser or bottom diode detector because the anode terminal electrode is operably coupled to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 , and a cathode terminal electrode is operably coupled to the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 .
- the anode terminal electrode is forwarded biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode such that holes are injected from the anode terminal electrode into the QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 in order to induce photon emission within the device structure.
- the n-type region of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 when present, floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode.
- the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode that is emitted vertically through the top surface of the device structure.
- the photon emission within the device structure produces the whispering gallery mode that circulates in the waveguide of the whispering gallery microresonator.
- the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator.
- the bottom diode laser operates by injecting holes into the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 is present (i.e., it has not been etched away, for example as described with reference to the device of FIGS.
- the upper n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 can contribute to emission. It is also noted that in order for this process to work, the upper n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 must be allowed to float in potential so to allow carrier diffusion mechanisms that stimulate such emission to operate.
- the anode terminal electrode is reversed biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode.
- the n-type region of the modulation doped QW structure 24 floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode.
- the reverse bias conditions are selected such that the device produces photocurrent proportional to the intensity of an optical signal absorbed by the device structure.
- the device structure absorbs the optical mode that is received vertically through the top surface of the device structure.
- the whispering gallery microresonator the device structure absorbs the whispering gallery mode that circulates in the waveguide region of the whispering gallery microresonator.
- the closed-loop microresonator the device structure absorbs the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator.
- At least one anode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the top p-type contact layer 30
- a bottom cathode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the bottom n-type contact layer 14
- an n-channel injector terminal can be operably coupled to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24
- a p-channel injector terminal can also be operably coupled to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 . Electrically, this configuration operates as an electrically-pumped thyristor laser or thyristor detector.
- the device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I s substantially greater than zero) when i) the anode terminal electrode is forward biased with respect to the cathode terminal electrode and ii) the voltage between n-channel injector and the anode electrode is biased such that charge is produced in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 32 that is greater than the critical switching charge Q CR , which is that charge that reduces the forward breakdown voltage such that no off state bias point exists.
- the voltage between p-channel injector electrode and cathode electrode can also be configured to produce a charge in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 that is greater than the critical switching charge Q CR .
- the critical switching charge Q CR is unique to the geometries and doping levels of the device.
- the device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the current I through device falls below the hold current of the device for a sufficient period of time such that the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or the charge in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) decreases below the holding charge Q H , which is the critical value of the channel charge which will sustain holding action.
- the device will switch to its conducting/ON state. If the current I in the conducting/ON state is above the threshold for lasing I TH , then photon emission will occur within the device structure. For the vertical cavity surface emitting laser, the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode that is emitted vertically through the top surface of the device structure.
- the photon emission within the device structure produces the whispering gallery mode signal that circulates in the waveguide region of the whispering gallery microresonator.
- the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator.
- the device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I is substantially greater than zero) in response to an input optical signal that produces charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 resulting from photon absorption of the input optical signal.
- the anode terminal electrode is forward biased with respect to the cathode terminal electrode and the voltage between n-channel injector and the anode electrode (and/or the voltage between the p-channel injector and the cathode tei minal electrode) is biased such that that charged produced in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) resulting from photon absorption of the input optical pulse is greater than the critical switching charge Q CR .
- the device When the input optical signal is removed, the device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) decreases below the holding charge Q H .
- the device structure absorbs the optical mode that is received vertically through the top surface of the device structure.
- the whispering gallery microresonator the device structure absorbs the whispering gallery mode that circulates in the waveguide region of the whispering gallery microresonator.
- the closed-loop microresonator the device structure absorbs the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator.
- a diffraction grating can be formed in the top mirror over the active device structure described above.
- the diffraction grating performs the function of diffracting light produced within the resonant vertical cavity into light propagating laterally in a waveguide which has the top DBR mirror and bottom DBR mirror 12 as waveguide cladding layers and which has lateral confinement regions.
- the diffraction grating performs the function of diffracting incident light that is propagating in the lateral direction into a vertical cavity mode, where it is absorbed resonantly in the vertical resonant cavity.
- FIGS. 2A-2B illustrate an embodiment of a whispering gallery microresonator 200 realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- the whispering gallery microresonator 200 is a bottom diode laser or optical detector as describe above. Thus, it can be configured as a laser or as an optical detector.
- the whispering gallery microresonator 200 includes a mesa 212 that is formed by etching the layer structure of FIG. 1 to a depth near the top of layer 22 , and then patterning and etching the resultant structure to define the inner annular sidewall 213 that forms the circular profile of the mesa 212 as evident from FIG. 2A .
- the inner sidewall 213 extends to an intermediate mesa 214 formed in the layer structure in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 .
- the intermediate mesa 214 has an annular profile as defined by the annular sidewall 213 and an annular sidewall 215 (which is offset radially inside the sidewall 213 ) as shown in FIG. 2B .
- Two ion implant regions 216 , 218 are defined by ion implantation through the intermediate mesa 214 .
- the ion implant regions 216 , 218 are similar to the ion implant regions 719 and 721 of the p-channel HFET as described above with respect to FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (i.e., p-type acceptor ions for the ion implant region 216 and oxygen species for the ion implant region 218 ) as described above.
- the implant region 216 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of the annular sidewall 213 as evident from FIG. 2B .
- the implant region 216 provides for electrical contact to the annular p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 that surrounds the implant region 216 .
- the ion implant region 218 (which has the deepest depth of the two implant regions) is implanted into the N+-type layer(s) 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of the annular sidewall 213 as evident from FIG. 2B . In this manner, the implant region 216 overlies the implant region 218 .
- the high resistance deep oxygen ion implant region 218 effectively blocks current flow therethrough and thus operates to funnel or steer current into the active region of the resonant cavity of the device.
- the current blocking oxygen ion implant region 218 defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 216 and the bottom N+-type ohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure.
- Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the anode terminal electrode 222 and the cathode terminal electrode 224 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form the annular sidewall 215 that extends downward to a central bottom mesa 220 formed in the bottom ohmic contact layer 14 .
- the bottom mesa 220 has a circular profile as defined by the annular sidewall 215 as best shown in FIG. 2A .
- This etching step can also remove the central portion of the implant regions 216 and 218 such that they each have an annular profile disposed laterally between the annular sidewall 215 and the projection of sidewall 213 as shown in FIG. 2B .
- An anode terminal electrode 222 is formed on the intermediate mesa 214 with an annular pattern that is offset laterally inside the annular sidewall 213 as best shown in FIGS. 2A and 2B .
- the anode terminal electrode 222 contacts the p-type ion implant regions 216 , which contact the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 of the device structure.
- a cathode terminal electrode 224 is formed on the bottom mesa 220 in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 as best shown in FIG. 2B .
- the cathode terminal electrode 224 can be patterned as a circular tab as best shown in FIG. 2A or can have some other shape.
- the metal of the anode terminal electrode 222 is preferably an Au—Be alloy
- the metal of the cathode terminal electrode 224 is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy.
- the resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the source, drain and gate electrodes as desired. In one embodiment, the resultant structure can be heated at 420° C. to treat the metal alloys of the anode and cathode electrodes of the device.
- Such metallization can be carried out in tandem with the metallization of the source, drain and gate electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect to FIGS. 7A and 7B or the electrode of other devices integrally formed on the substrate 10 .
- the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form sidewalls 226 that extend from the top mesa 212 to the mirror layers 12 .
- One of the sidewalls 226 - 1 forms the outer annular periphery of the top mesa 212 .
- Two other sidewalls 226 - 2 and 226 - 3 form a waveguide rib that defines a coupling waveguide 230 extending tangential to the outer annular sidewall 226 - 1 of the resonator device as best shown on FIG. 2A .
- the sidewall 226 - 2 of the coupling waveguide 230 is offset from the annular sidewall 226 - 1 by a narrow gap 232 and the height of the coupling waveguide 230 can match the height of the mesa 212 as best shown in FIG. 2B .
- a trench etch can expose the bottom mirror layers 12 in the vicinity of both the whispering gallery microresonator 200 and the coupling waveguide 230 .
- the exposed bottom minor layers 12 can be oxidized in steam ambient.
- a dielectric top mirror (not shown) can cover the top mesa 212 and the annular sidewalls of the microresonator 200 and the coupling waveguide 230 .
- the dielectric material of the top minor can fill the gap 232 .
- the index changes provided by the top mesa 212 (together with the top mirror when present), the inner annular sidewall 213 , the outer annular sidewall 226 - 1 , the ion implant regions 216 , 218 , and the bottom DBR mirror 12 form a resonant cavity with an disk-shaped annular volume that is configured to support a whispering gallery optical mode signal.
- the thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can be configured to correspond to at or near one wavelength (for example, a thickness at or near 1 ⁇ m for a whispering gallery optical mode signal in the near-infrared range of the electromagnetic spectrum).
- the thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can encompass relatively equal portions of the layer structure of FIG.
- the coupling waveguide 230 provides for evanescent coupling of light to and/or from the resonant cavity of the whispering gallery microresonator device 200 .
- the whispering gallery microresonator device 200 can operate as an electrically-pumped bottom diode laser or bottom diode detector.
- the anode terminal electrode 222 is forward biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode 224 such that holes are injected from the anode terminal electrode 222 into the QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 in order to induce photon emission within the device structure.
- the current-blocking ion implant region 218 funnels the injected hole current that flow from the anode terminal electrode 222 and the p-type contact implant region 216 into the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 within the annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device.
- Such current funneling enhances the current density of the injected current in the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 within the annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device, which can improve the output power of the device and/or lower the laser threshold voltage of the device.
- the anode terminal electrode 222 is reversed biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode 224 .
- An input optical light is supplied to the coupling waveguide 230 , which couples the input optical light as a whispering gallery mode signal that propagates in the annular resonant cavity of the whispering gallery microresonator device 200 for absorption by the device structure.
- the reverse bias conditions of the anode terminal electrode 222 and the cathode terminal electrode 224 are configured such the diode detector produces photocurrent between the anode terminal electrode 222 and the cathode terminal electrode 224 that is proportional to the intensity of the whispering gallery optical mode absorbed by the device structure.
- the photocurrent flows between the anode terminal 222 and cathode terminal 224 under the reverse bias.
- the current-blocking ion implant region 218 substantially reduces dark leakage current, which can greatly reduce the sensitivity of the device if not addressed.
- FIGS. 3A-3B illustrate an embodiment of a closed-loop (ring) microresonator 300 realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- the ring microresonator 300 is a bottom diode laser or optical detector as described above. Thus, it can be configured as a laser or as an optical detector.
- the ring microresonator 300 includes a top mesa 311 , an intermediate mesa 312 that is surrounded by the top mesa 311 , and a central bottom mesa 313 that is surrounded by the intermediate mesa 312 .
- the top mesa 311 is formed by the top surface of layer 30 of the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- the intermediate mesa 312 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 to define the annular sidewall 314 that forms the outer circular profile of the mesa 312 as evident from FIG. 3A .
- the sidewall 314 extends to the intermediate mesa 313 formed in the layer structure in the spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 .
- the intermediate mesa 312 has an annular profile as defined by the annular sidewall 314 and an annular sidewall 315 (which is offset radially inside the sidewall 314 ) as shown in FIG. 3B .
- Two ion implant regions 316 , 318 are defined by ion implantation through the intermediate mesa 312 .
- the ion implant regions 316 , 318 are similar to the ion implant regions 719 and 721 of the p-channel HFET as described above with respect to FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (i.e., p-type acceptor ions for the ion implant region 316 and oxygen species for the ion implant region 318 ) as described above.
- the implant region 316 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of the annular sidewall 314 as evident from FIG. 3B .
- the implant region 316 provides for electrical contact to the annular p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 that surrounds the implant region 316 .
- the ion implant region 318 (which has the deepest depth of the two implant regions) is implanted into the N+-type layer 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of the annular sidewall 314 as evident from FIG. 3B . In this manner, the implant region 316 overlies the implant region 318 .
- the high resistance deep oxygen ion implant region 318 effectively blocks current flow therethrough and thus operates to funnel or steer current into the active region of the resonant cavity of the device.
- the current blocking oxygen ion implant region 318 defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 316 and the bottom N+-type ohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure.
- Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the anode terminal electrode 322 and the cathode terminal electrode 324 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form the annular sidewall 315 that extends downward to the bottom mesa 313 formed in the bottom ohmic contact layer 14 .
- the bottom mesa 313 has a circular profile as defined by the annular sidewall 313 as best shown in FIG. 3A .
- This etching step can also remove the central portion of the implant regions 316 and 318 such that they each have an annular profile disposed laterally between the annular sidewall 315 and the projection of sidewall 314 as shown in FIG. 3B .
- An anode terminal electrode 322 is formed on the intermediate mesa 312 with an annular pattern that is offset laterally inside the annular sidewall 314 as best shown in FIGS. 3A and 3B .
- the anode terminal electrode 322 contacts the p-type ion implant regions 316 , which contact the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 of the device structure.
- a cathode terminal electrode 324 is formed on the bottom mesa 313 in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 as best shown in FIG. 3B .
- the cathode terminal electrode 224 can be patterned as a circular tab as best shown in FIG. 3A or can have some other shape.
- the metal of the anode terminal electrode 322 is preferably an Au—Be alloy
- the metal of the cathode terminal electrode 324 is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy.
- the resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the source, drain and gate electrodes as desired. In one embodiment, the resultant structure can be heated at 420° C. to treat the metal alloys of the anode and cathode electrodes of the device.
- Such metallization can be carried out in tandem with the metallization of the source, drain and gate electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect to FIGS. 7A and 7B or the electrode of other devices integrally formed on the substrate 10 .
- the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form sidewalls 326 that extend from the top mesa 311 to the mirror layers 12 .
- One of the sidewalls 326 - 1 forms the outer annular periphery of the top mesa 311 .
- Two other sidewalls 326 - 2 and 326 - 3 form a waveguide rib that defines a coupling waveguide 330 extending tangential to the outer annular sidewall 326 - 1 of the resonator device 300 as best shown on FIG. 3A .
- the sidewall 326 - 2 of the coupling waveguide 330 is offset from the annular sidewall 326 - 1 by a narrow gap 332 and the height of the coupling waveguide 330 can match the height of the mesa 31 as best shown in FIG. 3B .
- a trench etch can expose the bottom mirror layers 12 in the vicinity of both the ring microresonator 300 and the coupling waveguide 330 .
- the exposed bottom mirror layers 12 can be oxidized in steam ambient.
- a dielectric top mirror (not shown) can cover the top mesa 311 and the annular sidewalls of the resonator 300 and the coupling waveguide 330 .
- the dielectric material of the top mirror can fill the gap 332 .
- the index changes provided by the top mesa 311 (together with the top mirror when present), the inner annular sidewall 314 , the outer annular sidewall 326 - 1 , the ion implant regions 316 , 318 , and the bottom DBR mirror 12 form a resonant cavity with a ring-shaped annular volume that is configured to support circulating propagation of an optical mode signal about the ring-shaped volume.
- the length of the optical path of the ring-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity is tuned to the particular wavelength of the optical mode signal that is to propagate in the resonant cavity. Specifically, the length L of the optical path is selected to conform to the following:
- the anode terminal electrode 322 is forwarded biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode 324 such that holes are injected from the anode terminal electrode 322 into the QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 in order to induce photon emission within the device structure.
- the current-blocking ion implant region 318 funnels or steers the injected hole current that flows from the anode terminal electrode 322 and the p-type contact implant region 316 into the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 within the ring-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device.
- Such current funneling or steering enhances the current density of the injected current in the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 within the ring-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device, which can improve the output power of the device and/or lower the laser threshold voltage of the device.
- the anode terminal electrode 322 is reversed biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode 324 .
- An input optical light is supplied to the coupling waveguide 330 , which couples the input optical light as an optical mode signal that circulates in the ring-shaped annular resonant cavity of the ring microresonator device 300 for absorption by the device structure.
- the anode terminal electrode 322 and the cathode terminal electrode 324 are configured such the diode detector produces photocurrent between the anode terminal electrode 322 and the cathode terminal electrode 324 that is proportional to the intensity of the optical mode signal absorbed by the device structure.
- the photocurrent flows between the anode terminal 322 and cathode terminal 324 under the reverse bias.
- the current-blocking ion implant region 318 substantially reduces dark leakage current, which can greatly reduce the sensitivity of the device if not addressed.
- FIGS. 4A-4B illustrate an embodiment of a whispering gallery thyristor microresonator 400 realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- the whispering gallery thyristor microresonator 400 is a thyristor laser or optical detector as describe above. Thus, it can be configured as a laser or as an optical detector.
- the whispering gallery thyristor microresonator 400 includes a top mesa 411 , a first intermediate mesa 412 that is disposed outside the outer periphery of the top mesa 411 , a second intermediate mesa 413 that is disposed outside the outer periphery of the first intermediate mesa 412 , a third inteimediate mesa 414 that is disposed inside the inner periphery of the top mesa 411 , and a central bottom mesa 415 that is disposed inside the inner periphery of the third intermediate mesa 414 .
- the top mesa 411 is formed by the top surface of layer 30 of the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- An anode terminal electrode 423 is formed on the top mesa 411 with an annular pattern as best shown in FIGS. 4A and 4B .
- the anode terminal electrode 423 contacts the top p-type ohmic contact layer 30 .
- the metal of the anode terminal electrode 423 can be tungsten or other suitable metal or alloy.
- the metal of the anode terminal electrode 423 can be patterned by a lift off by oxide process as described below with respect to FIGS. 9A-9D .
- the first intermediate mesa 412 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in layer(s) 26 above (but near) the n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 24 to define the annular sidewall 416 that forms the inner circular profile of the mesa 412 as evident from FIG. 4A .
- the sidewall 416 extends to the first intermediate mesa 412 formed in the layer structure in the layer(s) 26 above (but near) the n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 24 .
- the first intermediate mesa 412 has an annular profile as defined by the annular sidewall 416 and an annular sidewall 417 (which is offset radially outside the sidewall 416 ) as shown in FIG. 4B .
- the patterned metal of the anode terminal electrode 423 can be used as a mask layer for the etch of the sidewall 416 if desired
- the second intermediate mesa 413 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth near the middle of spacer layer(s) 22 to define the annular sidewall 417 that forms the inner circular profile of the second intermediate mesa 413 as evident from FIG. 4A .
- the sidewall 417 extends to the second intermediate mesa 413 formed in the layer structure near the middle of the spacer layer(s).
- the third intermediate mesa 414 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 to define the annular sidewall 418 that forms the outer circular profile of the third intermediate mesa 414 as evident from FIG. 4A .
- the sidewall 418 extends to the third intermediate mesa 414 formed in the layer structure in the spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 .
- the third intermediate mesa 414 has an annular profile as defined by the annular sidewall 418 and an annular sidewall 419 (which is offset radially inside the sidewall 418 ) as shown in FIG. 4B .
- the patterned metal of the anode terminal electrode 423 can be used as a mask layer for the etch of the sidewall 418 if desired.
- An ion implant region 420 is defined by ion implantation of n-type ions through the first intermediate mesa 412 .
- the ion implant 420 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally outside the projection of the annular sidewall 416 as evident from FIG. 4B .
- the implant region 420 provides for electrical contact to the annular n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 that surrounds the implant region 420 .
- Two ion implant regions 421 , 422 are defined by ion implantation through the intermediate mesa 414 .
- the ion implant regions 421 , 422 are similar to the ion implant regions 719 and 721 of the p-channel HFET as described above with respect to FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (i.e., p-type acceptor ions for the ion implant region 421 and oxygen species for the ion implant region 422 ) as described above.
- the implant region 421 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of the annular sidewall 418 as evident from FIG. 4B .
- the implant region 421 provides for electrical contact to the annular p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 that surrounds the implant region 421 .
- the ion implant region 422 (which has the deepest depth of the two implant regions) is implanted into the N+-type layer 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of the annular sidewall 418 as evident from FIG. 4B . In this manner, the implant region 421 overlies the implant region 422 .
- the high resistance deep oxygen ion implant region 422 effectively blocks current flow therethrough and thus operates to funnel or steer current into the active region of the resonant cavity of the device.
- the current blocking oxygen ion implant region 422 defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 421 and the bottom N+-type ohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure.
- Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the p-channel injector terminal electrode 425 and the cathode terminal electrode 426 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form the annular sidewall 419 that extends downward to the central bottom mesa 415 formed in the bottom ohmic contact layer 14 .
- the bottom mesa 415 has a circular profile as defined by the annular sidewall 419 as best shown in FIG. 4A .
- This etching step can also remove the central portion of the implant regions 421 and 422 such that they each have an annular profile disposed laterally between the annular sidewall 419 and the projection of sidewall 418 as shown in FIG. 4B .
- An n-channel injector terminal electrode 424 is formed on the first intermediate mesa 412 as best shown in FIGS. 4A and 4B .
- the n-channel injector terminal electrode 424 contacts the n-type ion implant region 420 , which contacts the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 of the device structure.
- a p-channel injector terminal electrode 425 is formed on the third intermediate mesa 414 with an annular pattern as best shown in FIGS. 4A and 4B .
- the p-channel injector terminal electrode 425 contacts the p-type ion implant region 422 , which contacts the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 of the device structure.
- a cathode terminal electrode 426 is formed on the bottom mesa 415 in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 as best shown in FIG. 4B .
- the cathode terminal electrode 426 can be patterned as a circular tab as best shown in FIG. 4A or can have some other shape.
- the metal of the p-channel injector terminal electrode 425 is preferably an Au—Be alloy, and the metal of the n-channel injector terminal 424 and the cathode terminal electrode 426 is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy.
- the resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the electrodes of the device as desired.
- the resultant structure can be heated at 420° C. to treat the metal alloys of the device.
- Such metallization can be carried out in tandem with the metallization of the source, drain and gate electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect to FIGS. 7A and 7B or the electrode(s) of other devices integrally formed on the substrate 10 .
- the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form sidewalls 427 that extend from the second intermediate mesa 413 to the mirror layers 12 .
- One of the sidewalls 427 - 1 folins the outer annular periphery of the resonator device such that the second intermediate mesa 413 of the resonator device 400 has an annular profile as defined by the annular sidewall 417 and the annular sidewall 427 - 1 (which is offset radially outside the sidewall 417 ) as shown in FIG. 4B .
- Two other sidewalls 427 - 2 and 427 - 3 form a waveguide rib that defines a coupling waveguide 430 extending tangential to the outer annular sidewall 427 - 1 of the resonator device 400 as best shown on FIG. 4A .
- the sidewall 427 - 2 of the coupling waveguide 430 is offset from the annular sidewall 427 - 1 by a narrow gap 432 and the height of the coupling waveguide 440 can match the height of the mesa 413 of the resonator device 400 as best shown in FIG. 4B .
- a trench etch can expose the bottom mirror layers 12 in the vicinity of both the thyristor whispering gallery microresonator 400 and the coupling waveguide 430 .
- the exposed bottom mirror layers 12 can be oxidized in steam ambient.
- a dielectric top mirror (not shown) can cover the mesas 413 , 412 , 411 and the annular sidewalls of the resonator 400 and the coupling waveguide 430 .
- the dielectric material of the top mirror can fill the gap 432 .
- the index changes provided by the mesa 413 (together with the top mirror when present), the inner annular sidewall 418 , the outer annular sidewall 427 - 1 , the ion implant regions 421 , 422 , and the bottom DBR mirror 12 form a resonant cavity with a disk-shaped annular volume that is configured to support a whispering gallery optical mode signal.
- the thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can be configured to correspond to at or near one wavelength (for example, a thickness at or near 1 ⁇ m for a whispering gallery optical mode signal in the near-infrared range of the electromagnetic spectrum).
- the thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can encompass relatively equal portions of the layer structure of FIG.
- the coupling waveguide 430 provides for evanescent coupling of light to and/or from the resonant cavity of the thyristor whispering gallery microresonator device 400 .
- the thyristor whispering gallery microresonator device 400 can operate as an electrically-pumped thyristor laser or thyristor detector.
- the device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I is substantially greater than zero) when i) the anode terminal electrode 423 is forward biased with respect to the cathode terminal electrode 426 and ii) the voltage between n-channel injector 424 and the anode electrode 423 is biased such that charge is produced in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 that is greater than the critical switching charge Q CR , which is that charge that reduces the forward breakdown voltage such that no off state bias point exists.
- the voltage between p-channel injector electrode 425 and the cathode electrode 426 can also be configured to produce a charge in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 that is greater than the critical switching charge Q CR .
- the critical switching charge Q CR is unique to the geometries and doping levels of the device.
- the device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the current I through device falls below the hold current of the device for a sufficient period of time such that the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or the charge in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) decreases below the holding charge Q H , which is the critical value of the channel charge which will sustain holding action.
- the device will switch to its conducting/ON state. If the current I in the conducting/ON state is above the threshold for lasing I TH , then photon emission will occur within the device structure.
- such photon emission produces the whispering gallery mode signal that circulates in the resonant cavity of the microresonator 400 , which is coupled to the coupling waveguide 430 to produce an output optical signal that propagates in the coupling waveguide 430 for output therefrom.
- the current-blocking ion implant region 421 funnels the current that flows from between the anode terminal electrode 423 and the cathode terminal electrode 426 into the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 within the disk-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device.
- Such current funneling enhances the current density of the injected current in the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 within the disk-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device, which can improve the output power of the device and/or lower the laser threshold voltage of the device.
- an input optical signal is supplied to the coupling waveguide 430 , which couples the input optical signal as a whispering gallery mode optical signal that circulates in the resonant cavity of the microresonator device 400 for absorption by the device structure.
- the device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I is substantially greater than zero) in response to the whispering gallery mode optical signal producing charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 resulting from photon absorption of the whispering gallery mode optical signal.
- the anode terminal electrode 423 is forward biased with respect to the cathode terminal electrode 426 and the voltage between n-channel injector 424 and the anode electrode 423 (and/or the voltage between the p-channel injector 425 and the cathode terminal electrode 626 ) is biased such that that charged produced in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) resulting from photon absorption of the whispering gallery mode optical signal is greater than the critical switching charge QCR.
- the device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) decreases below the holding charge Q H .
- the current-blocking ion implant region 421 reduces the capacitance between the p-channel injector terminal electrode 425 and the cathode terminal electrode 426 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- FIGS. 5A-5E illustrate a configuration of a closed-loop microresonator 500 that can be made utilizing the layer structure of FIG. 1 , which includes a resonator 501 spaced from a section of a zig-zag waveguide structure 509 by a gap region 513 .
- the zig-zag waveguide structure 509 is optically coupled to the resonator 501 by evanescent-wave coupling over the gap region 513 .
- the resonator 501 defines a resonant cavity, which is referred to herein as active waveguide 502 , that follows a closed path that is generally rectangular in shape.
- the optical path length of the active waveguide 502 is tuned to the particular wavelength of the optical mode signal 504 that is to propagate in the waveguide 502 .
- the length of the rectangular closed path of the active waveguide 502 is given as 2(L 1 +L 2 ) and the L 1 and L 2 parameters are selected to conform to the following:
- the optical mode 504 circulates around the active waveguide 502 and is strongly confined within the active waveguide 502 by internal reflection at the reflective interfaces of the active waveguide 502 .
- the zig-zag waveguide 509 defines a passive rib waveguide that forms a zig-zag path.
- the optical mode is strongly confined within the zig-zag waveguide 509 by internal reflection at the reflective interfaces of the zig-zag waveguide 509 .
- the active waveguide 502 can be logically partitioned in four sections that are coupled to one another by ninety-degree corners as shown in FIG. 5A .
- the four sections include a straight section 503 A that extends parallel to and is closely-spaced from a straight section 511 of the zig-zag waveguide 509 by the gap region 513 , a straight section 503 B disposed opposite the straight section 503 A, and two straight sections 503 C and 503 D that are opposed to one another and that extend orthogonal to the sections 503 A and 503 B between the corresponding opposed ends of the sections 503 A and 503 B.
- Section 503 A is configured to provide evanescent coupling to (or from) the straight section 511 of the zig-zag waveguide 509 for the optical mode signal 504 that circulates in the active waveguide 502 .
- Sections 503 B and 503 C are configured to contribute to the generation (or absorption) of the optical mode signal 504 that circulates in the active waveguide 502 .
- Section 503 D has a number of portions that perform different functions. Specifically, section 503 D has two opposed end portions 505 A, 505 B that are configured in a manner similar to sections 503 B and 503 C to contribute to the generation (or absorption) of the optical mode signal 504 that circulates in the active waveguide 502 .
- Segment 503 D also has a central portion 507 that is electrically isolated from the two opposed end portions 505 A, 505 B by corresponding passive waveguide portions 509 A and 509 B as shown. The central portion 507 is configured to provide tuning of the wavelength of the optical mode signal 504 that circulates in the active waveguide 502 .
- FIG. 5B is a cross-sectional schematic view of section 503 C of the active waveguide 502 . All of the features of the cross-section extend laterally along the length of section 503 C as evident from FIG. 5A .
- “inner” refers to features that are closer to the center of the waveguide 502
- “outer” refers to features that are further away from the center of the waveguide 502 .
- These features include a top mesa 515 defined between an inner sidewall 517 A and an outer sidewall 517 B.
- Ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B can be implanted to a depth within the top layers 26 , 28 , 30 on opposite sides of waveguide 502 adjacent the respective sidewalls 517 A, 517 B as shown.
- the waveguide ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B can provide an index change that operates to aid in confining and guiding the optical mode signal 504 that propagates within the central region of the waveguide 502 .
- the inner sidewall 517 A extends downward to an inner mesa 519 A (which extends laterally to an inner sidewall 521 A), while the outer sidewall 517 B extends downward to an outer mesa 519 B (which extends laterally to an outer sidewall 521 A).
- Both the inner mesa 519 A and the outer mesa 519 B are formed in the layer structure in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 .
- Two implant regions 523 A , 525 A are defined by ion implantation through the inner mesa 519 A.
- the ion implant regions 523 A, 525 A are similar to the ion implant regions 719 and 721 of the p-channel HFET as described above with respect to FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (p-type acceptor ions for the implant region 523 A and oxygen ions for the implant region 525 A) as described above.
- the implant region 523 A (which has the shallowest depth of the two implant regions 523 A, 525 A) has a pattern that is disposed laterally between the inner sidewall 521 A and the projection of the inner sidewall 517 A as shown in FIG. 5B .
- the implant region 523 A provides for electrical contact to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- the implant region 525 A (which is deeper in depth than the implant region 523 A) is implanted into the N+-type layer 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally between the inner sidewall 521 A and the projection of the inner sidewall 517 A as shown in FIG. 5B . In this manner, the implant region 523 A overlies the implant region 525 A.
- the high resistance deep oxygen ion implant region 525 A effectively blocks current flow therethrough and defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 523 A and the bottom N+-type ohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure.
- Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the anode terminal electrode part 533 A and the cathode terminal electrode part 531 A of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- two implant regions 523 B, 525 B are defined by ion implantation through the outer mesa 519 B.
- the ion implant regions 523 B, 525 B are similar to the ion implant regions 719 and 721 of the p-channel HFET as described above with respect to FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (p-type acceptor ions for the implant region 523 B and oxygen ions for the implant region 525 B) as described above.
- the implant region 523 A (which has the shallowest depth of the two implant regions 523 B, 525 B) has a pattern that is disposed laterally between the outer sidewall 521 B and the projection of the outer sidewall 517 B as shown in FIG. 5B .
- the implant region 523 B provides for electrical contact to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- the implant region 525 B (which is deeper in depth than the implant region 523 B) is implanted into the N+-type layer 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally between the outer sidewall 521 B and the projection of the outer sidewall 517 B as shown in FIG. 5B . In this manner, the implant region 523 B overlies the implant region 525 B.
- the high resistance deep oxygen ion implant region 525 B effectively blocks current flow therethrough and defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 523 A and the bottom N+-type ohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure.
- Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the anode terminal electrode part 533 B and the cathode terminal electrode part 531 B of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- the inner sidewall 521 A extends downward to an inner bottom mesa 527 A formed in the bottom ohmic contact layer 14 .
- the inner bottom mesa 527 A extends laterally from the inner sidewall 521 A to an inner sidewall 529 A as shown in FIG. 5B .
- the outer sidewall 521 B extends downward to an outer bottom mesa 527 B formed in the bottom ohmic contact layer 14 .
- the outer bottom mesa 527 B extends laterally from the inner sidewall 521 B to the inner sidewall 529 B as shown in FIG. 5B .
- Two parts ( 531 A, 531 B) of a cathode terminal electrode are formed on the inner and outer bottom mesas 527 A, 527 B, respectively, in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 as best shown in FIG. 5B .
- Two parts ( 533 A, 533 B of an anode terminal electrode are formed on the inner and outer mesas 519 A, 519 B, respectively, in contact with their respective implant regions 525 A, 525 B.
- n-type region of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 of section 503 C floats with respect to the electrical signals supplied to anode terminal electrode parts 533 A, 533 B as well as to the cathode terminal electrode parts 531 A, 531 B.
- a top mirror 535 can cover the top mesa 515 and the sidewalls 517 A, 517 B.
- the top mesa 515 (or the top mirror 535 when present), the sidewalls 517 A, 517 B and the bottom DBR mirror 12 form part of the closed-path resonant cavity waveguide that is configured to support circulation of the optical mode signal 504 within the resonant cavity waveguide.
- the width of the resonant cavity waveguide i.e., the lateral offset between the sidewalls 517 A, 517 B
- the height of the vertical cavity waveguide can be above sixty percent of the waveguide width.
- FIG. 5C is a cross-sectional schematic view of the tuning portion 507 of section 503 D of the active waveguide 502 . All of the features of the cross-section extend laterally along the length of the tuning portion 507 as evident from FIG. 5A . These features include the top mesa 515 defined between the inner sidewall 517 A and the outer sidewall 517 B. Ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B (preferably of n-type ions) can be implanted to a depth within the top layers 26 , 28 , 30 on opposite sides of waveguide 502 adjacent the respective sidewalls 517 A, 517 B as shown.
- the ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B can provide an index change that operates to aid in confining and guiding the optical mode signal 504 that propagates within the central region of the waveguide 502 .
- the top mesa 515 , the sidewalls 517 A, 517 B and the waveguide implant regions 516 A, 516 B can be extensions of the top mesa, the sidewalls and the waveguide ion implant regions that form the resonant rib waveguide of the other sections of the resonator 500 .
- the inner sidewall 517 A extends downward to an inner mesa 559 A (which extends laterally to an inner sidewall 561 A), while the outer sidewall 517 B extends downward to an outer mesa 559 B (which extends laterally to an outer sidewall 561 B). Both the inner mesa 559 A and the outer mesa 559 B are fowled in the layer structure in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 . Implant regions 523 A, 525 A are defined by ion implantation through the inner mesa 559 A, while implant regions 523 B, 525 B are defined by ion implantation through the outer mesa 559 B.
- the implant regions 523 A, 525 A, 523 B, 525 B are similar to those described above for section 503 C of FIG. 5B .
- the inner sidewall 561 A extends downward to an inner bottom mesa 567 A formed in the bottom ohmic contact layer 14 .
- the inner bottom mesa 567 A extends laterally from the inner sidewall 561 A to an inner sidewall 569 A as shown in FIG. 5C .
- the outer sidewall 561 B extends downward to an outer bottom mesa 567 B formed in the bottom ohmic contact layer 14 .
- the outer bottom mesa 567 B extends laterally from the outer sidewall 561 B to the outer sidewall 569 B as shown in FIG. 5C .
- Two parts ( 571 A, 571 B) of a first tuning terminal electrode are formed on the inner and outer mesas 559 A, 559 B, respectively, in contact with their respective implant regions 523 A, 523 B which contact the QW of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 of the tuning portion 507 .
- Two parts ( 573 A, 573 B) of a second tuning terminal electrode are formed on the inner and outer bottom mesas 567 A, 567 B, respectively, in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 of the tuning portion 507 as best shown in FIG. 5C .
- the high resistance deep oxygen ion implant regions 525 A, 525 B effectively blocks current flow therethrough and defines isolation regions between the respective p-type implant regions 523 A/ 523 B and the bottom N+-type ohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure.
- Such isolation regions are each substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduce the capacitance between the first tuning electrode parts 571 A, 571 B and the cathode teitninal electrode parts 573 A, 573 B of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- n-type region of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 of the tuning portion 507 floats with respect to the electrical signals supplied to tuning electrode parts 571 A, 571 B, 573 A, 573 B.
- a top mirror 535 can cover the top mesa 515 and the sidewalls 517 A, 517 B.
- FIG. 5D is a cross-sectional schematic view of the isolating passive waveguide portion 509 B of section 503 D of the active waveguide 502 . All of the features of the cross-section extend laterally along the length of the passive waveguide portion 509 B as evident from FIG. 5A . These features include the top mesa 515 defined between the inner sidewall 517 A and the outer sidewall 517 B. Ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B (preferably of n-type ions) can be implanted to a depth within the top layers 26 , 28 , 30 on opposite sides of waveguide 502 adjacent the respective sidewalls 517 A, 517 B as shown.
- Ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B preferably of n-type ions
- the ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B can provide an index change that operates to aid in confining and guiding the optical mode signal 504 that propagates within the central region of the waveguide 502 .
- the top mesa 515 , the sidewalls 517 A, 517 B and the waveguide ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B can be extensions of the top mesa, sidewalls and waveguide ion implant regions that form the resonant rib waveguide of the other sections of the resonator 500 .
- the inner and outer sidewalls 517 A extends downward to bottom mirror layers 12 .
- a top mirror 535 can cover the top mesa 515 and the sidewalls 517 A, 517 B.
- the passive waveguide portion 509 B is formed adjacent one end of the tuning portion 507 , while another passive waveguide portion 509 A is formed adjacent the opposed end of tuning portion 507 of segment 503 D.
- the passive waveguide portion 509 A has the same features as passive waveguide portion 509 B of FIG. 5D .
- the opposed passive waveguide portions 509 A and 509 B provide electrical isolation of the tuning portion 507 from the two opposed end portions 505 A, 505 B of the active waveguide.
- FIG. 5E is a cross-sectional schematic view of the coupling section 503 A of the active waveguide 502 and the straight section 511 of the zigzag waveguide 509 with the gap region 513 therebetween. All of the features of the cross-section extend laterally along the length of the tuning portion 507 as evident from FIG. 5A . These features include the top mesa 515 defined between inner sidewall 517 A and an outer sidewall 517 B. Ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B (preferably of n-type ions) can be implanted to a depth within the top layers 26 , 28 , 30 on opposite sides of waveguide 502 adjacent the respective sidewalls 517 A, 517 B as shown.
- Ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B preferably of n-type ions
- the ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B can provide an index change that operates to aid in confining and guiding the optical mode signal 504 that propagates within the central region of the waveguide 502 .
- the top mesa 515 , the sidewalls 517 A, 517 B and the waveguide ion implant regions 516 A, 516 B can be extensions of the top mesa, sidewalls and waveguide ion implant regions that form the resonant rib waveguide of the other sections of the resonator 500 .
- the inner sidewall 517 A extends downward to an inner mesa 519 A (which extends laterally to an inner sidewall 521 A), while the outer sidewall 517 B extends downward to the mirror layers 12 .
- the inner mesa 519 A is formed in the layer structure in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 .
- Implant regions 523 A, 525 A are defined by ion implantation through the inner mesa 519 A.
- the implant regions 523 A, 525 A are similar to those described above for section 503 C of FIG. 5B .
- the inner sidewall 521 A extends downward to an inner bottom mesa 527 A formed in the bottom ohmic contact layer 14 .
- the inner bottom mesa 527 A extends laterally from the inner sidewall 521 A and an inner sidewall 569 A as shown in FIG. 5E .
- a first control electrode 581 is formed on the inner mesas 519 A in contact with the implant region 523 A, which is in contact with the QW of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 of the active waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 .
- a second control electrode 583 is formed on the inner bottom mesa 527 A in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 of the active waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 as best shown in FIG. 5E .
- the high resistance deep oxygen ion implant region 525 A effectively blocks current flow therethrough and defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 523 A and the bottom N+-type ohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure.
- Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the first control electrode 581 and the second control electrode 583 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. Note that the n-type region of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 floats with respect to the electrical signals supplied to first control terminal electrode 581 .
- the straight section 511 of the zig-zag waveguide 509 is formed from the layer structure of FIG. 1 by patterning and etching the layer structure to form opposed sidewalls 581 - 1 and 585 - 2 that extend from the top surface 501 to the mirror layers 12 .
- the sidewall 585 - 1 of the straight section 511 is offset from the sidewall 517 B of the coupling section 503 A by the gap region 513 as shown.
- a top mirror (not shown) can cover the top mesa 515 and the sidewalls of the devices.
- the etching that forms the sidewalls and mesas of the sections of the resonator 501 and the coupling waveguide 509 , the ion implantation operations and associated RTA operations for the sections of the sections of the resonator 501 and the coupling waveguide 509 , as well as the metallization of the terminal electrodes of the resonator 501 can be carried in tandem with the formation of like structures in other devices integrally formed on the substrate 10 .
- certain portions of the resonator 501 i.e., sections 505 A, 505 B, 503 B, and 503 C) can operate as an electrically-pumped bottom diode laser or bottom diode detector.
- the anode terminal electrode (parts 533 A, 533 B) is forwarded biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode (parts 531 A, 531 B) such that holes are injected from the anode terminal electrode (parts 533 A, 533 B) into the QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 in order to induce photon emission within the waveguide 502 of the device structure.
- the current-blocking deep oxygen ion implant regions ion implant regions 525 A, 525 B can aid in funneling the injected hole current that flows from the anode terminal electrode parts 533 A, 533 B and the p-type contact implant regions 525 A, 525 B into the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 within the waveguide 502 of the device structure.
- Such current funneling enhances the current density of the injected current in the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 within the waveguide 502 of the device structure, which can improve the output power of the device and/or lower the laser threshold current and voltage of the device.
- the deep oxygen ion implant regions 525 A, 525 B define isolation regions that significantly reduce the capacitance between the anode terminal electrode (parts 533 A, 533 B) and the cathode terminal electrode (parts 531 A, 531 B). This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- the anode terminal electrode (parts 533 A, 533 B) is reversed biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode (parts ( 531 A, 531 B).
- An input optical light is supplied to the coupling waveguide 509 , which couples the input optical light as an optical mode signal 504 that propagates in the waveguide 502 of the resonator 501 for absorption by the device structure.
- the reverse bias conditions of the anode terminal electrode (parts 533 A, 533 B) and the cathode terminal electrode (parts 531 A, 531 B) are configured such the diode detector produces photocurrent between the anode terminal electrode (parts 533 A, 533 B) and the cathode terminal electrode (parts 531 A, 531 B) that is proportional to the intensity of the optical mode signal 504 absorbed by the device structure.
- the photocurrent flows between the anode terminal electrode (parts 533 A, 533 B) and cathode terminal electrode (parts 531 A, 531 B) under the reverse bias.
- the current-blocking ion implant regions 525 A, 525 B substantially reduces dark leakage current, which can greatly reduce the sensitivity of the device if not addressed.
- Electrical signals can be supplied to the first control electrode 581 and the second control electrode 583 of the coupling section 503 in order to change the coupling coefficient of the evanescent coupling between the waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 and the straight section 511 of the coupling waveguide 509 .
- the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between the two waveguides can be changed (i.e., modulated) by controlling the amount of charge (holes) that fills the QW(s) of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 for the waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 , which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 for the waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 .
- Charge can be added to (or removed from) the QW(s) of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 by a suitable bias current source and/or bias current sink that is electrically coupled to the first control electrode 581 .
- the second control electrode 883 tied to ground potential.
- a DC electrical signal can be supplied to the first control electrode 581 and the second control electrode 583 in order to activate and deactivate the evanescent coupling between the waveguide 502 and the straight section 511 of the coupling waveguide 509 .
- a time-varying differential electrical signal can be supplied to the first control electrode 581 and the second control electrode 583 in order to modulate the evanescent coupling between the waveguide 502 and the straight section 511 of the coupling waveguide 509 .
- Such coupling modulation generates a modulated optical signal based upon the optical mode signal 504 that propagates in the waveguide 502 of the resonator 501 .
- the modulated optical signal propagates through the straight section 511 of the coupling waveguide 509 and is output therefrom.
- the modulated optical signal can have an optical OOK modulation format (i.e., digital pulsed-mode optical signal) or possibly a higher order optical modulation format (such as optical differential phase shift keying format or optical differential quadrature phase shift keying format).
- Electrical signals can be supplied to the first tuning electrode (parts 571 A, 571 B) and the second tuning electrode (parts 573 A, 573 B) of the tuning portion 507 of section 503 D in order to tune the characteristic wavelength ⁇ D of the optical mode signal 504 that propagates in the waveguide 502 .
- the bias signal between the first tuning electrode (parts 571 A, 571 B) and the second tuning electrode (parts 573 A, 573 B) can populate the QW(s) of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 with holes, which shifts the absorption edge to shorter wavelengths and thus induces a significant index change.
- the index change can modify the length of the optical path of the waveguide 502 and therefore change the characteristic wavelength ⁇ D of the optical mode signal 504 that propagates in the waveguide 502 .
- the active portions of the resonator 501 can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact to top layer 30 for an anode terminal electrode (or parts thereof) and electrical contact to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for a cathode terminal electrode or parts thereof.
- the active portions of the resonator 501 i.e., sections 505 A, 505 B, 503 B, and 503 C
- the coupling section 503 C of the resonator 501 can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact to top layer 30 for a first control terminal electrode and electrical contact to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for a second control electrode that are used to control the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between the waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 and the straight section 511 of the coupling waveguide 509 .
- the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between two waveguides can be changed (i.e., modulated) by controlling the amount of charge (electrons) that fills the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for the waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 , which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for the waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 .
- the tuning section 507 of the resonator 501 can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact to top layer 30 for a first tuning electrode and electrical contact to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for a second tuning electrode that are used to tune the characteristic wavelength ⁇ D of the optical mode signal 504 that propagates in the waveguide 502 .
- the characteristic wavelength ⁇ D of the optical mode signal 504 can be changed (i.e., modulated) by controlling the amount of charge (electrons) that fills the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for the waveguide 502 of the tuning section 507 , which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for the tuning section 507 of the waveguide 502 and the optical path length of the waveguide 502 of the resonator.
- the amount of charge (electrons) that fills the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for the waveguide 502 of the tuning section 507 , which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for the tuning section 507 of the waveguide 502 and the optical path length of the waveguide 502 of the resonator
- the active portions of the resonator 501 can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact to top layer 30 for an anode terminal electrode (or parts thereof) as well as electrical contact to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for an n-channel injector terminal electrode or parts thereof as well as electrical contact to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 for a p-channel injector terminal electrode or parts thereof as well as electrical contact to the bottom n-type contact layer 14 for a cathode terminal electrode or parts thereof.
- the active portions of the resonator 501 can operate as a thyristor laser or thyristor detector as described herein.
- the coupling section 503 C of the resonator 501 can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact to top layer 30 , to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 , to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 , and to the bottom n-type contact layer 14 for control terminal electrodes that are used to control the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between the waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 and the straight section 511 of the coupling waveguide 509 .
- the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between two waveguides can be changed (i.e., modulated) by controlling the amount of charge that fills the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 and/or QW(s) of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 for the waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 , which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the n-type or p-type modulation doped QW structures for the waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 .
- the tuning section 507 of the resonator 501 can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact to top layer 30 , to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 , to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 , and to the bottom n-type contact layer 14 for tuning electrodes that are used to tune the characteristic wavelength ⁇ D of the optical mode signal 504 that propagates in the waveguide 502 .
- the characteristic wavelength ⁇ D of the optical mode signal 504 that propagates in the waveguide 502 can be changed (i.e., modulated) by controlling the amount of charge that fills the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 and/or QW(s) of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 for the waveguide 502 of the tuning section 507 , which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the n-type or p-type modulation doped QW structures for the waveguide 502 of the tuning section 507 and the optical path length of the waveguide 502 of the resonator.
- the tuning section 507 can be realized as part of any one of the other optical resonator structures as described herein in order to provide tunability of the wavelength of the optical mode processed by the optical resonator structure.
- FIGS. 5F-5H illustrate a configuration of a closed-loop (rectangular path) microresonator 500 ′ that includes a resonator 501 ′ and electrically-controlled tuning reflector 591 that are realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- the resonator 501 ′ is spaced from a section of a zig-zag waveguide structure 509 ′ by a gap region.
- the zig-zag waveguide structure 509 ′ is optically coupled to the resonator 501 ′ by evanescent-wave coupling over the gap region. Similar to the resonator 501 of the embodiment of FIGS.
- the resonator 501 ′ defines an active waveguide 502 ′ that follows a closed path that is generally rectangular in shape.
- the optical path length of the active waveguide 502 ′ is tuned to the particular wavelength of the optical mode signal that is to propagate in the waveguide 502 ′.
- the tuning section and isolating passive waveguide sections of the waveguide 502 of the embodiment of FIGS. 5A-5E is omitted and replaced with an active section similar to the section 503 C of FIG. 5B .
- wavelength tuning functionality is carried out by the tuning reflector 591 that is formed as part of the coupling waveguide 509 .
- the active waveguide 502 ′ of the resonator 501 ′ is configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact to top layer 30 for an anode terminal electrode (or parts thereof) and electrical contact to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for a cathode terminal electrode or parts thereof.
- a collector terminal can be in electrical contact to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 if desired.
- the active waveguide 502 ′ of the resonator 501 ′ can operate as a top diode laser or top diode detector as described herein.
- the coupling section of the resonator 501 ′ can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact to top layer 30 for a first control terminal electrode and electrical contact to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 for a second control electrode that are used to control the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between the waveguide 502 ′ of the coupling section and the straight section of the coupling waveguide 509 ′ as described herein.
- the resonator 501 ′ produces light that propagates in both the clockwise and counterclockwise sense along the optical path of the waveguide 502 ′ of the resonator 501 ′ as indicted by the two sets of arrows in FIG. 5F .
- the evanescent coupling between the coupling section of the resonator 501 ′ and the straight section of the coupling waveguide 509 ′ operates on both clockwise and counterclockwise light propagation within the resonator 501 ′.
- the light propagating clockwise within the resonator 501 ′ is coupled to the coupling waveguide 509 ′ to produce light that propagates in the coupling waveguide 509 ′ toward the right side of FIG. 5F
- light propagating counterclockwise within the resonator 501 ′ is coupled to the coupling waveguide 509 ′ to produce light that propagates in the coupling waveguide 509 ′ toward the left side of FIG. 5F .
- the evanescent coupling between the straight section of the coupling waveguide 509 ′ and the coupling section of the resonator 501 ′ operates on both directions of light propagation within the coupling waveguide 509 ′.
- light propagating in the straight section of the coupling waveguide toward the right side of FIG. 5F is coupled to the resonator 501 ′ to produce light that propagates clockwise in the resonator 501 ′
- light propagating in the straight section of the coupling waveguide toward the left side of FIG. 5F is coupled to the resonator 501 ′ to produce light that propagates counterclockwise in the resonator 501 ′.
- the tuning reflector 591 is a linear active waveguide device formed as a reflector that builds upon the multiple directions of light propagation in the resonator 501 ′ as well as the multiple directions of evanescent coupling provided between the straight section of the coupling waveguide 509 ′ and the coupling section of the resonator 501 ′.
- the tuning reflector 591 has Bragg grating (such as a first-order or third-order Bragg grating) defined throughout the length of the active waveguide device.
- the Bragg grating can be defined by etching into the top layers (such as layers 26 , 28 , 30 of layer structure of FIG. 1 ) as shown in FIG. 5G .
- the Bragg grating operates to reflect any optical modes exiting the straight section of coupling waveguide 509 in the direction of the tuning reflector 591 where the wavelength of such optical modes coincides with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating. All optical modes at other wavelengths will be passed through the tuning reflector 591 or be absorbed.
- the resonator 501 ′ produces optical mode(s) that propagate counter-clockwise within the waveguide 502 ′ of the resonator 501 ′, which are coupled into the coupling waveguide 509 ′ to produce optical mode(s) that propagate in the coupling waveguide 509 ′ to the tuning reflector 591 .
- the incident optical mode(s) at wavelengths that coincide with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of the tuning reflector 591 are reflected back and propagate in the reverse direction within the coupling wave guide 509 ′ where the mode is coupled into the resonator 501 ′ to produce optical mode(s) that propagates clockwise in the resonator 501 ′ and generate more stimulated emission.
- This operation is repeated many times such that the wavelength of dominant optical mode that propagates in the resonator 501 corresponds to the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating.
- Such dominant optical mode propagating clockwise in the resonator 501 is coupled to the coupling waveguide 509 to produce an output optical signal (which propagates in the direction away from the tuning reflector 591 and labeled “desired output direction” in FIG. 5F ).
- optical modes that coincide with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of the tuning reflector 591 make double passes through the resonator 501 ′ for improved stimulated emission.
- This operation is repeated such that the wavelength of the dominant or primary optical mode that propagates in the resonator 501 ′ corresponds to the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating.
- the dominant or primary optical mode that propagates in the resonator 501 ′ is output from the coupling waveguide 509 ′, while optical modes that do not coincide with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of the tuning reflector 591 are removed from the output signal by the operation of the tuning reflector 591 .
- the input optical signal is supplied to the coupling waveguide 509 ′ from the end opposite the tuning reflector 591 .
- Such input optical signal is coupled into the resonator 501 ′ to produce optical mode(s) that propagate counter-clockwise within the waveguide 502 ′ of the resonator 501 ′ for absorption.
- Some counter-clockwise propagating optical modes that are not absorbed can be coupled into the coupling waveguide 509 ′ to produce optical mode(s) that propagate in the coupling waveguide 509 ′ to the tuning reflector 591 .
- the incident optical mode(s) with wavelengths that coincide with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of the tuning reflector 591 are reflected back and propagate in the reverse direction within the coupling waveguide 509 ′ where the mode is coupled into the resonator 501 ′ to produce optical mode(s) that propagate clockwise in the resonator 501 ′ for additional absorption.
- optical modes that coincide with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of the tuning reflector 591 make double passes through the resonator 501 ′. This operation is repeated such that the wavelength of the dominant or primary optical mode that propagates in the resonator 501 ′ corresponds to the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating.
- the Bragg grating functions as a narrow-band filter where the Bragg frequency of grating that dictates the wavelength of the dominant or primary optical mode that propagates in the resonator 501 ′.
- Such narrow-band filtering is useful for larger closed-loop resonators where the natural mode resonances are closely spaced from one another and thus do not provide a narrow wavelength band for the optical mode that propagates in the closed-loop resonator.
- the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of the tuning reflector 591 can be electronically-controlled (or tuned) by controlled injection of charge that modifies the index of the region n2 of the Bragg grating as noted in FIG. 5L .
- the charge injection can be controlled by traveling wave surface electrode parts 592 A, 592 B that are formed on the top surface 30 on opposite sides of the Bragg grating along the length of the device as shown in FIG. 5G .
- Ion implanted source regions 593 A and 593 B are also formed on opposite sides of the Bragg grating along the length of the device and in contact with the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 of the device.
- Waveguide implants 594 A, 594 B can be formed on opposite sides of the Bragg grating at or near the same depth of the Bragg grating along the length of the device as shown. Intermediate electrode parts 595 A, 595 B are formed in contact with the ion implanted source regions 593 A and 593 B.
- the traveling wave surface electrode parts 592 A, 592 B form a CPW (Coplanar Waveguide) traveling wave transmission line which is ideal to implement high speed tunability.
- a collector terminal electrode 596 can be formed on an ion implant region 597 that contacts the p-type modulation doped interface 20 of the device structure.
- a top mirror can be formed over the device structure as shown in FIG. 5H .
- the CPW defined by traveling wave surface electrode parts 592 A, 592 B can be terminated in its characteristic impedance Z o , and the intermediate electrode parts 595 A, 595 B can be coupled to ground potential as noted in FIG. 5F .
- Charge injection that modulates the index n2 can be controlled by applying a traveling wave electrical RF signal to the CPW, and the Bragg grating frequency corresponding to the time dependent index n2 value can be obtained. Because the tuning is achieved by charge injection into the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 of the device, the collector bias can change the voltage at which this happens similar to the threshold voltage of an HFET. Therefore the voltage window for tuning can be adjusted for the range of input signal.
- the maximum change of index n2 for a given charge injection level will be obtained.
- the closed-loop microresonator 500 ′ of FIGS. 5F-5G can be configured to provide the functionality equivalent to a tunable DFB laser with higher speed, wider tunability, and a wider variety of electronic integration than is currently not possible in state-of-the-art technology.
- the tuning reflector 591 can be realized as part of the coupling waveguide structure in conjunction with any one of the other optical resonator structures as described herein in order to provide tunability of the wavelength of the optical mode processed by the optical resonator structure.
- FIGS. 6A-6C illustrate a split-electrode vertical cavity surface emitting device 600 realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- the device 600 can logically be partitioned into two parts, a left half 601 and a right half 602 that each have a generally half-circular top profile as shown in FIG. 6A .
- a top mesa 612 extends across both the left half 601 and the right half 603 as best shown in FIG. 6B .
- a first intermediate mesa 618 is defined on the left side 601 outside the outer periphery of the top mesa 612 .
- the first intermediate mesa 618 is formed above (but near) the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 .
- a second intermediate mesa 620 is defined on the right side 603 outside the outer periphery of top mesa 612 and opposite the first intermediate mesa 618 .
- the second intermediate mesa 620 is formed above (but near) the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 .
- a bottom mesa 622 is defined by the n-type layer 14 outside the periphery of both the first intermediate mesa 618 and the second intermediate mesa 620 and extends across both the left half 601 and the right half 603 as best shown in FIG. 6B .
- the top mesa 612 is formed by the top surface of layer 30 of the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- An ion implant region 616 (preferably of n-type ions) can be implanted through the top mesa 612 to a depth within the one or more the top p-type layers 28 , 30 on the left half 601 of the device.
- the ion implant region 616 can have a half-circle profile that provides a current barrier that funnels current injected from the anode terminal electrode 614 into the active region 650 defined by the right half 602 of the device as illustrated by arrow 651 in FIG. 6B .
- the anode terminal electrode 614 is formed on the top mesa 612 with a half-circle pattern as best shown in FIG. 6A .
- the anode terminal electrode 614 contacts the top p-type ohmic contact layer 30 .
- the metal of the anode terminal electrode 614 can be tungsten or other suitable metal or alloy.
- the metal of the anode terminal electrode 614 as well as the implant region 616 can be formed by a lift off by oxide process as described below with respect to FIGS. 9A-9D .
- the first intermediate mesa 618 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in layer(s) 26 above (but near) the n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 24 to define the sidewall that forms the half-circle profile of the mesa 618 for the left half 601 of the device as evident from FIG. 6A .
- the patterned metal of the anode terminal electrode 614 can be used as a mask layer for the etch of this sidewall if desired.
- the second intermediate mesa 620 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 to define the sidewall that forms the half-circle profile of the mesa 620 for the right half 602 of the device as evident from FIG. 6A .
- An ion implant region 624 is defined by ion implantation of n-type ions through the first intermediate mesa 618 .
- the ion implant 624 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 with the half-circle pattern that is disposed laterally outside the projection of the sidewall that leads to the first intermediate mesa.
- the implant region 624 provides for electrical contact to the annular n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 of the two halves 601 , 602 of the device.
- An ion implant region 626 is defined by ion implantation of p-type ions through the second intermediate mesa 620 .
- the implant region 626 provides for electrical contact to the annular p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 of the two halves 601 , 602 of the device.
- a rapid thermal anneal (RTA) oxide can be deposited on the resultant structure and RTA operations are carried out to activate the implant regions 624 and 626 as desired.
- the ion implant region 626 is similar to the ion implant region 719 of the p-channel HFET as described above with respect to FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with this implants with the same p-type acceptor ions species and annealed as described above.
- High resistance deep oxygen ion implant regions 628 A and 628 B are then implanted in the bottom n+ contact layer 14 through the intermediate mesas 618 and 620 for the left and right halves 601 and 602 of the device, where such high resistance effectively blocks current flow therethrough.
- the oxygen ion implant regions 628 A and 628 B form a near complete circle with a gap 630 that is devoid of the current blocking oxygen ions.
- An RTA is then performed in order to activate the oxygen ion implant regions 628 A, 628 B.
- the ion implant regions 628 A, 628 B is similar to the ion implant region 721 of the p-channel HFET as described above with respect to FIG. 7 and can be implanted together and annealed as described above.
- the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form the annular sidewalls that extends downward to the bottom mesa 622 formed in the bottom ohmic contact layer 14 .
- the bottom mesa 622 has a circular profile outside the periphery of the first intermediate mesa 618 and the second intermediate mesa 620 for the left and right halves 601 , 602 of the device.
- An n-channel injector terminal electrode 632 is formed on the first intermediate mesa 618 of the left half 601 with a half-circle pattern as best shown in FIGS. 6A and 6B .
- the n-channel injector terminal electrode 632 contacts the n-type ion implant region 624 , which contacts the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 of the device structure.
- a p-channel injector terminal electrode 634 is formed on the second intermediate mesa 620 of the right half 602 with a half-circle pattern as best shown in FIGS. 6A and 6B .
- the p-channel injector terminal electrode 634 contacts the p-type ion implant region 626 , which contacts the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 of the device structure.
- the gap 630 of the oxygen implant region is positioned adjacent a cathode terminal electrode 636 (which is preferably shaped as a small tab) that is formed on a portion of the bottom mesa 622 adjacent the gap 630 as evident from the FIGS. 6A and 6C .
- the gap 630 provides a narrow pathway for current flow from the active region 650 to the cathode terminal electrode 636 as evident from FIG. 6C .
- the metal of the p-channel injector terminal electrode 634 is preferably an Au—Be alloy
- the metal of the n-channel injector teiminal 632 and the cathode terminal electrode 636 is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy.
- the resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the electrodes of the device as desired.
- Such metallization can be carried out in tandem with the metallization of the source, drain and gate electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect to FIGS. 7A and 7B or the electrode(s) of other devices integrally formed on the substrate 10 .
- a trench etch can expose the bottom mirror layers 12 .
- the exposed bottom mirror layers 12 can be oxidized in steam ambient.
- a top mirror (not shown) can cover the mesas 612 , 618 , 620 and the sidewalls of the device 600 , if desired.
- the index changes provided by the top mesa 612 (together with the top mirror when present), the sidewalls of the right half 601 , the current blocking implant 616 , and the bottom DBR mirror 12 form a resonant cavity of a vertical cavity laser emitter or detector.
- the top surface of the mesa 612 of the right half 602 defines an aperture that leads to the active region 650 of this vertical cavity.
- the vertical cavity thyristor device 500 can operate as an electrically-pumped thyristor laser or thyristor detector.
- the device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I is substantially greater than zero) when i) the anode teuninal electrode 614 is forward biased with respect to the cathode terminal electrode 636 and ii) the voltage between n-channel injector 632 and the anode electrode 614 is biased such that charge is produced in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 that is greater than the critical switching charge Q CR , which is that charge that reduces the forward breakdown voltage such that no off state bias point exists.
- the voltage between p-channel injector electrode 634 and the cathode electrode 636 can also be configured to produce a charge in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 that is greater than the critical switching charge Q CR .
- the critical switching charge Q CR is unique to the geometries and doping levels of the device.
- the device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the current I through device falls below the hold current of the device for a sufficient period of time such that the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or the charge in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) decreases below the holding charge Q H , which is the critical value of the channel charge which will sustain holding action.
- the device will switch to its conducting/ON state. If the current I in the conducting/ON state is above the threshold for lasing I TH , then photon emission will occur within the device structure. For the vertical cavity thyristor device 600 , such photon emission produces an optical signal that exits through the aperture in the top mesa 612 for output therefrom.
- the current-blocking oxygen ion implant regions 628 A, 628 B funnels the current that flows from between the anode terminal electrode 614 and the cathode terminal electrode 636 into the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 within the vertical resonant cavity of the device.
- Such current funneling enhances the current density of the injected current in the QW channel of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 within the vertical resonant cavity of the device, which can improve the output power of the device and/or lower the laser threshold voltage of the device.
- an input optical signal is injected through the aperture in the top mesa 612 into the vertical cavity of the device for absorption by the device structure.
- the device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I is substantially greater than zero) in response to the optical signal producing charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 resulting from photon absorption of the optical signal.
- the anode terminal electrode 614 is forward biased with respect to the cathode terminal electrode 636 and the voltage between n-channel injector 632 and the anode electrode 614 (and/or the voltage between the p-channel injector 634 and the cathode terminal electrode 636 ) is biased such that that charged produced in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) resulting from photon absorption of the whispering gallery mode optical signal is greater than the critical switching charge Q CR .
- the device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 ) decreases below the holding charge Q H .
- the current-blocking ion implant regions 628 A, 628 B reduces the capacitance between the p-channel injector terminal electrode 634 and the cathode teitninal electrode 636 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- FIGS. 8A to 8C illustrate a dual-wavelength hybrid device 800 realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- the dual-wavelength hybrid device 800 is a hybrid of two parts: a central part that operates as a vertical cavity device at a first wavelength corresponding to the material of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 , and an outside part that operates as a whispering gallery mode device at a second wavelength corresponding to the material of the p-type modulation doped structure 20 .
- the device 800 includes a top mesa 812 with an annular shallow trench that forms a first intermediate mesa 814 .
- a bottom mesa 824 is defined outside the outer periphery of the second intermediate mesa 822 .
- the top mesa 812 is formed by the top surface of layer 30 of the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- a split anode terminal electrode with two concentric annular parts 818 A, 818 B is formed on the top mesa 812 as best shown in FIGS. 8A and 8B .
- the anode terminal electrode parts 818 A, 818 B both contact the top p-type ohmic contact layer 30 .
- the metal of the anode terminal electrode parts 818 A, 818 B can be tungsten or other suitable metal or alloy.
- Two ion implant regions 820 A, 820 B can be implanted through the top mesa 812 to a depth within the top layers 26 , 28 , 30 .
- the ion implant regions 820 A, 820 B can have concentric circular profiles that provide current barriers that funnel current injected from the anode terminal electrode parts 818 A, 818 B into both central and peripheral active regions of the device.
- the metal of the anode terminal electrode parts 818 A, 818 B as well as the ion implant regions 820 A, 820 B can be patterned by a lift off by oxide process as described below with respect to FIGS. 9A-9D .
- the shallow trench that defines the first intermediate mesa 814 is disposed between the two anode terminal electrode parts 818 A, 818 B and can formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in layer(s) 26 above (but near) the n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 24 .
- the first intermediate mesa 814 has an annular profile that is concentrically located between the two anode terminal electrode parts 818 A, 818 B.
- the patterned metal of the two anode terminal electrode parts 818 A, 818 B can be used as a mask layer for the etch of this shallow trench if desired.
- the second intermediate mesa 822 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 as evident from FIG. 8B .
- the second intermediate mesa 822 is defined by an annular sidewall 817 - 1 that extends down from the outer periphery of the top mesa 812 as shown in FIGS. 8B and 8C .
- the second intermediate mesa 822 has a generally annular profile that extends laterally outside the outer periphery of the top mesa 812 as evident from FIGS. 8A and 8B .
- the patterned metal of the outside anode terminal electrode part 818 B can be used as a mask layer for the etch of the sidewall 817 - 1 if desired.
- the outside current blocking implant region 820 can be offset laterally from the sidewall 817 - 1 as evident from FIG. 8B .
- the patterning and etching of the sidewall 817 - 1 can also define two opposed sidewalls 817 - 2 and 817 - 3 of a waveguide rib that defines a coupling waveguide 838 extending tangential to the outer annular sidewall 817 - 1 of the device 800 as best shown on FIG. 8A .
- the sidewall 817 - 2 of the coupling waveguide 838 is offset from the annular sidewall 817 - 1 by a narrow gap 840 and the height of the coupling waveguide 838 can match the height of the top mesa 812 of the device 400 as best shown in FIG. 8C .
- An ion implant region 825 is defined by ion implantation of n-type ions through the first intermediate mesa 814 .
- the ion implant 825 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally within the projections of the annular sidewalls of the shallow top trench as evident from FIG. 8B .
- the implant region 825 provides for electrical contact to the annular n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 that surrounds the implant region 825 on both sides of the implant region 825 .
- Two ion implant regions 828 , 830 are defined by ion implantation through the second intermediate mesa 822 .
- the ion implant regions 828 , 830 are similar to the ion implant regions 719 and 721 of the p-channel HFET as described above with respect to FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (p-type acceptor ions for the implant region 828 and oxygen ions for the implant regions 830 ) and annealed as described above.
- the implant region 828 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally outside the projection of the annular sidewall that extends downward to the second intermediate mesa 822 as evident from FIG. 8B .
- the implant region 828 provides for electrical contact to the annular p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 that is surrounded by the implant region 828 .
- the ion implant region 830 (which has the deepest depth of the two implant regions) is implanted into the N+-type layer 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally outside the projection of the annular sidewall that extends downward to the second intermediate mesa 822 as evident from FIG. 8B .
- the implant region 828 overlies the implant region 830 .
- the high resistance deep oxygen ion implant region 830 effectively blocks current flow therethrough and thus operates to funnel or steer current into the active region of the resonant cavity of the device.
- the current blocking oxygen ion implant region 820 defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 828 and the bottom N+-type ohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure.
- Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the p-channel injector terminal electrode 834 and the cathode terminal electrode 836 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form a generally annular sidewall that extends downward to the bottom mesa 824 formed in the bottom ohmic contact layer 14 .
- the bottom mesa 824 has a generally circular profile outside the periphery of the second intermediate mesa 822 as shown in FIG. 8A .
- An n-channel injector tettninal electrode 816 is formed on the first intermediate mesa 814 with an annular pattern as best shown in FIGS. 8A and 8B .
- the n-channel injector terminal electrode 816 contacts the n-type ion implant region 825 , which contacts the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 of the device structure.
- a p-channel injector terminal electrode 834 is formed on the second intermediate mesa 822 with a generally annular pattern as best shown in FIGS. 8A and 8B .
- the p-channel injector terminal electrode 834 contacts the p-type ion implant region 828 , which contacts the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 of the device structure.
- the gap 832 in the deep oxygen ion implant region 830 is positioned adjacent a cathode terminal electrode 836 (which is preferably shaped as a small tab) that is formed on a portion of the bottom mesa 824 adjacent the gap 832 as evident from the FIGS. 8A and 8C .
- the gap 832 provides a narrow pathway for current flow from the central and peripheral active regions to the cathode terminal electrode 836 as evident from FIG. 8C . Similar to the source, drain, gate and collector terminal electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect to FIGS.
- the metal of the p-channel injector terminal electrode 834 is preferably an Au—Be alloy
- the metal of the n-channel injector terminal 832 and the cathode terminal electrode 836 is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy.
- the resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the electrodes of the device as desired.
- Such metallization can be carried out in tandem with the metallization of the source, drain and gate electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect to FIGS. 7A and 7B or the electrode(s) of other devices integrally formed on the substrate 10 .
- a trench etch can expose the bottom mirror layers 12 .
- the exposed bottom mirror layers 12 can be oxidized in steam ambient.
- a dielectric top mirror (not shown) can cover the mesas 812 , 822 , 824 and the sidewalls of the device 800 , if desired.
- the dielectric material of the top mirror can fill the gap 840 .
- the index changes provided by the top mesa 812 (together with the top mirror when present and the bottom DBR mirror 12 in the central region of the device and possible other parts of the device foam a resonant cavity of a thyristor vertical cavity laser emitter or detector.
- the top surface of the mesa 812 in the central region of the device (which is left open and not covered by the anode metal portions 818 A, 818 B) defines an aperture that leads to the central active region of this vertical cavity.
- the index changes provided by the top mesa 812 (together with the top mirror when present), the sidewall 817 - 1 of the device, the implants 820 B, 826 , 828 , and the bottom DBR mirror 12 in the periphery of the device form a resonant cavity having an annular volume that supports propagation of a whispering gallery mode.
- the thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can be configured to correspond to at or near one wavelength (for example, a thickness at or near 1 for a whispering gallery optical mode signal in the near-infrared range of the electromagnetic spectrum).
- the thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can encompass relatively equal portions of the layer structure of FIG. 1 above and below the p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 .
- the coupling waveguide 838 provides for evanescent coupling of light to and/or from the peripheral resonant cavity of the device 800 that supports propagation of a whispering gallery mode.
- the device 800 can be configured to perform a first optical mode conversion function where an in-plane optical signal (which is input to the coupling waveguide 838 ) is converted to a vertical optical mode signal that is emitted from the central aperture of the device 800 .
- a whispering gallery mode is coupled into the peripheral resonant cavity from the coupling waveguide 838 by evanescent coupling. This whispering gallery mode propagates around the peripheral resonant cavity, where it is absorbed by the device structure.
- Such absorption adds charge to the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or to the P-type modulation doped structure 20 ) such that the channel charge exceeds the critical switching charge Q CR , which turns the central thyristor vertical cavity device ON.
- the ON current is configured to produce a vertical cavity mode for output.
- the first optical mode conversion function can be configured to perform wavelength conversion where the in-plane optical signal input to the coupling waveguide 838 is at a first wavelength ⁇ 1 (e.g., 980 nm), and the vertical mode emitted from the central active region of the device 800 is at a second wavelength ⁇ 2 (e.g., 1310 nm).
- the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 can include one or more QD layers that are configured to absorb at the first wavelength ⁇ 1
- the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 can include one or more QD layers that are configured to emit at second wavelength ⁇ 2 .
- the electrodes of the device are biased such that the thyristor action turns ON in response to detection of the whispering gallery mode at the first wavelength ⁇ 1 and turns OFF when the whispering gallery mode at the first wavelength ⁇ 1 is not present, and the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 with suitable QD layers emit at the second wavelength ⁇ 2 when the thyristor action is ON.
- the second optical mode conversion function can be configured to perform wavelength conversion where vertical mode injected into the central active region of the device 800 is at a first wavelength ⁇ 1 (e.g., 1310 nm), and the in-plane optical signal output by the coupling waveguide 838 is at a second wavelength ⁇ 2 (e.g., 980 nm).
- the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 can include one or more QD layers that are configured to absorb at the first wavelength ⁇ 1
- the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20 can include one or more QD layers that are configured to emit at second wavelength ⁇ 2 .
- the electrodes of the device are biased such that the thyristor action turns ON in response to detection of the vertical cavity mode at the first wavelength ⁇ 1 and turns OFF when the vertical cavity mode at the first wavelength ⁇ 1 is not present, and the p-type modulation doped QW structure 24 with suitable QD layers emit at the second wavelength ⁇ 2 when the thyristor action is ON.
- the current-blocking ion implant regions 628 A, 628 B operate to funnel or steer current into the active regions for the resonant cavities of the device, and also reduce the capacitance between the p-channel injector terminal electrode 834 and the cathode teiuiinal electrode 686 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced.
- FIG. 9A to 9D illustrate exemplary fabrication steps that form dopant implant regions that are self-aligned to patterned metal for an aperture that is part of optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit wafer that employs the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- An aperture is formed at the top surface of the layer structure to allow for light to exit or enter into the active region of the device.
- Anode metal regions and/or implant regions can be used to block light from exiting or entering into the active region of the device structure and thus form the boundary of the aperture.
- a first mask is deposited and patterned on the top surface 901 of layer 30 of the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- the first mask comprises a dual layer structure of oxide and nitride as shown.
- the mask preferably has a thickness of 4000-5000 A.
- the pattern of the mask defines a feature 901 that protects the area of the aperture 905 that results from the process as shown in FIG. 9D .
- one or more implant regions are implanted into the layer structure outside the mask feature 903 .
- the one or more implant regions are implanted to a depth that encompasses one or more of the p-type layers 26 and 28 of the layer structure of FIG. 1 .
- the implant region 9 s) employ n-type species of sufficient density that convert the p-type implanted region to n-type and produce a pn junction that blocks the flow of hole current flow vertically downwards. This forces the hole current to flow laterally to the un-implanted active region of the device structure disposed below the aperture 905 .
- the implant region(s) can be implanted to a depth below the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 . This requires higher energy to place the implant regions below such QW(s).
- the implant regions 907 A, 907 B operate to increase the “as grown” barrier to conduction of holes by the addition of more n type doping near the modulation doping of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 .
- the larger barrier means that p-type conduction over this barrier is reduced and so the hole current from the top contact flows laterally where the barrier is lower (i.e., the vertically down conduction is blocked) preferentially to the un-implanted active region of the device structure disposed below the aperture 905 .
- the ions species of the implant region(s) can be Si ions due to its lower mass and larger possible range. SiF ions may also be used.
- the advantage of locating the current blocking implant region(s) below the QW of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 is that the top p-type layers 28 and 30 can be made thinner (preferably a 1/2 ⁇ , above the QW), which makes it easier to fabricate HFETs with a lower profile topology.
- the implant region(s) can also provide for lateral confinement of light within the active region of the device structure disposed below the aperture 905 .
- the metal material 909 for the top surface electrode which can be tungsten or some other suitable metal or metal alloy, is deposited such that it covers the top surface 901 and the mask feature 903 as shown in FIG. 9B .
- a second mask 911 (preferably formed from photoresist material) is deposited and patterned to define a window that overlies the mask feature 903 .
- the window is used as part of an etch operation that etches through the window down through the metal 909 and the mask feature 901 to a depth at or near the top surface 901 in the area that results in the aperture 905 .
- the window is smaller than the width of the mask feature 901 , and thus leaves behind one or more sidewalls (such as the opposed sidewalls 915 A, 915 B) of the mask feature 901 .
- the sidewall(s) of the mask feature can have a width dimension on the order of 1-2 ⁇ m.
- This etch operation can employ an anisotropic etching process that define a near vertical profile for the sidewall(s) of the mask feature.
- An example of a suitable anisotropic etching process is dry reactive ion etching employing SF6.
- the resultant structure is etched in BOE (Buffered Oxide Etch).
- BOE Borered Oxide Etch
- the BOE etches sideways and undercuts the sidewall(s) (e.g., sidewalls 915 A, 915 B) of the mask feature 901 as well as the adjacent sidewall(s) of the metal material 909 and the overlying second mask 911 (if present) to form the resultant structure as shown in FIG. 9D .
- the aperture 905 is formed between the opposed surface electrode parts 909 A, 909 B. This procedure is designated lift-off by oxide.
- the current blocking implant(s) are disposed adjacent the aperture 905 below the corresponding surface electrode. Specifically, the opposed edge(s) of the implant region(s) are aligned laterally with the opposed edges of the surface electrode that define the boundaries of the aperture.
- This self-aligned configuration of the implant region(s) and the surface electrode is advantageous because it can eliminate one mask procedure, aid in minimizing resistance of the top surface layers 26 , 28 , 30 and aid in producing uniformity and higher yield over large areas.
- the surface electrode that define the boundaries of the aperture can be patterned and etched away after metallizing all of the electrodes of the devices of the integrated circuit and prior to depositing the dielectric material of the top mirror of such device, if used.
- the n-type and p-type doping characteristics of the epitaxial layer of FIG. 1 can be reversed with respect to one another.
- the bottom layers 14 ′, 16 ′ have p-type doping.
- the bottom layer 14 ′ provides a P+-type ohmic contact layer.
- An n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20 ′ can be formed above the bottom layers 14 ′, 16 ′.
- the n-type modulation doped structure 20 ′ has a layer of N+-type modulation doping on the bottom side of the structure 20 ′.
- a p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 24 ′ can be formed above the n-type modulation doped structure 20 ′.
- the p-type modulation doped structure 24 ′ has a layer of P+-type modulation doping on the top side of the structure 24 ′.
- the top layers 26 ′, 30 ′ have n-type doping.
- the top layer 30 ′ provides an N+-type ohmic contact layer.
- any one of the optical resonators as described herein can be replicated to form an array of optical emitters or detectors for parallel optical data links or wavelength division multiplexed operations.
- any one of the optical resonator and coupling waveguide systems as described herein can be replicated and positioned adjacent one another to provide for optical switching functions between input and output waveguides and possibly other optical functions as desired.
- the devices as described herein can be formed from the device structure of FIG. 10 , which includes a bottom distributed Bragg reflector (DBR) mirror layers 1003 formed on substrate 1001 .
- the bottom DBR mirror layers 1003 are typically formed by depositing pairs of semiconductor or dielectric materials with different refractive indices. When two materials with different refractive indices are placed together to foul' a junction, light will be reflected at the junction. The amount of light reflected at one such boundary is small.
- a metamorphic buffer 1005 that significantly reduces strain due lattice mismatch between the overlying active device structure and the underlying bottom DMR mirror layers 1003 and substrate 1001 .
- the metamorphic buffer 1005 accommodates lattice mismatch between the underlying structure (bottom DBR mirror layers 1003 and substrate 1001 ) and the overlying structure (the alloys of the active device structure) and absorbs strain due to such lattice mismatch while minimizing the nucleation of dislocations.
- Deposited on the metamorphic buffer 1005 is one or more spacer layers 1007 followed by an active device structure suitable for realizing complementary heterostructure field-effect transistor (HFET) devices.
- HFET complementary heterostructure field-effect transistor
- the first of these complementary HFET devices is a p-channel HFET which has a p-type modulation doped quantum well (QW) structure 1015 with an n-type gate region (i.e., bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1009 and bottom n-type region layer(s) 1011 ) below the p-type modulation doped QW structure 1015 .
- One or more spacer layers 1013 is disposed between the p-type modulation doped quantum well (QW) structure 1015 and the underlying bottom n-type layer(s) 1011 .
- One or more spacer/barrier layers 1017 are disposed above the p-type modulation doped QW structure 1015 .
- a QD-In-QW structure 1019 is formed above the spacer/barrier layer(s) 1017 , where the QD-In-QW structure 1019 includes at least one QW layer with self-assembled quantum dots (QDs) embedded therein.
- the second of these complementary HFET devices is an n-channel HFET which includes an n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 with a p-type gate region (i.e., p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1033 and p-type layer(s) 1031 ) formed above the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 .
- One or more spacer layers 1029 is disposed between the n-type modulation doped quantum well (QW) structure 1027 and the overlying p-type layer(s) 1031 .
- One or more spacer/barrier layers 1025 are formed below the n-type modulation doped quantum well (QW) structure 1027 .
- a QD-In-QW structure 1023 is formed below the spacer/barrier layer(s) 1025 , where the QD-In-QW structure 1023 includes at least one QW layer with self-assembled quantum dots (QDs) embedded therein.
- One or more spacer layer(s) 1021 are formed between the QD-In-QW structure 1019 and the QD-In-QW structure 1023 .
- the layers encompassing the spacer layer(s) 1021 and the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 forms the collector region of the p-channel HFET.
- the layers encompassing the spacer layer 1021 and the p-type modulation doped QW structure 1015 forms the collector region of the n-channel HFET.
- collector regions are analogous to the substrate region of a MOSFET device as is well known. Therefore a non-inverted n-channel HFET device is stacked upon an inverted p-channel HFET device as part of the active device structure.
- the active device layer structure begins with bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1009 which enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto.
- Deposited on layer(s) 1009 are one or more n-type layers 1011 and one or more spacer layer(s) 1013 which serve electrically as part of the gate of the p-channel HFET device and optically as a part of the lower waveguide cladding of the device.
- Deposited on layer(s) 1013 is the p-type modulation doped QW structure 1015 that defines a p-type charge sheet offset from one or more QWs (which may be formed from strained or unstrained heterojunction materials) by an undoped spacer layer.
- the p-type charge sheet is formed first below the undoped spacer and the one or more QWs of the p-type modulation doped QW structure 1015 . All of the layers grown thus far form the p-channel HFET device with the gate ohmic contact on the bottom.
- Deposited on the p-type modulation doped QW structure 1015 is one or more spacer/barrier layers 1017 .
- Deposited on the spacer/barrier layer(s) 1017 is the QD-In-QW structure 1019 (which corresponds to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 1015 ).
- the spacer layer(s) 1021 is then formed on the QD-In-QW structure 1019 .
- the QD-In-QW structure 1023 (which corresponds to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 ) followed by one or more spacer layers(s) 1025 .
- the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 is formed on the spacer layer(s) 1025 .
- the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 defines an n-type charge sheet offset from one or more QWs by an undoped spacer layer. The n-type charge sheet is formed last above the undoped spacer and the one or more QWs of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 .
- Deposited on the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 is one or more spacer layer(s) 1029 and one or more p-type layers 1031 , which can serve electrically as part of the gate of the n-channel HFET and optically as part of the upper waveguide cladding of the device.
- the p-type layers 1031 include two sheets of planar doping of highly doped p-material separated by a lightly doped layer of p-material. These p-type layers are offset from the n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 1027 by the spacer layer(s) 1029 .
- the top charge sheet achieves low gate contact resistance and the bottom charge sheet defines the capacitance of the n-channel HFET with respect to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 .
- Deposited on p-type layer(s) 1031 is one or more p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1033 , which enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto.
- Deposited on the p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1033 is an optical guide layer 1035 .
- the self-assembled quantum dots (QDs) embedded within the QD-in-QW structures 1019 and 1023 improves the efficiency of the optoelectronic devices realized from the active device structure of FIG. 10 .
- the population inversion necessary for laser action and amplification and the photon absorption mechanism for necessary for optical detection occurs more efficiently with the introduction of the quantum dots and thus decreases the necessary current required for lasing action and amplification increases the photocurrent produced by absorption.
- the size of the embedded QDs can be controlled to dictate the wavelength of the desired optical function (emission for lasing, amplification, absorption for detection).
- the size of the QDs in either or both QD-in-QW structures 1019 , 1023 can be controlled to dictate the wavelength in range from 1300 nm up to 1550 nm for use in the O to L (1260-1625 nm) bands employed in commercial optical telecommunication networks.
- the density distribution of the embedded QDs can be controlled to dictate the laser output power. High density of embedded QDs can provide for an increase of laser output power, but require a greater threshold lasing current.
- the QD-in-QW structures 1019 and 1023 can be realized by first and second bilayer structures with an undoped barrier layer therebetween. Both the first and second bilayer structures include a template substructure offset from an emission substructure by a thin undoped barrier layer as described in detail in US. patent application Ser. No. 13/921,311, which was filed on Jun. 19, 2013, hereinafter incorporated by reference in its entirety.
- the template substructures each include an un-graded QW with self-assembled QDs embedded therein.
- the self-assembled QDs can be formed during molecular beam epitaxy growth by a self-assembly method known as the Stranski-Krastanov process.
- an initial layer such as InGaAs
- a compound semiconductor that is lattice mismatched relative to the initial layer and underlying layer is deposited on the initial layer.
- the lattice mismatch of the compound semiconductor is such that the growth forms three dimensional islands after a deposition of a critical thickness of the compound semiconductor.
- the growth is continued to allow the three dimensional islands to expand to form the self-assembled QDs that have the desired characteristic dimensional range.
- the deposition of the ungraded QW material resumes such that the self-assembled QDs are covered and fully embedded within the ungraded QW material.
- the emission substructures each include an analog-graded QW with self-assembled QDs embedded therein.
- the self-assembled QDs can be formed during molecular beam epitaxy growth by a self-assembly method known as the Stranski-Krastanov process similar to the growth conditions of the template substructure.
- an initial layer such as InGaAs
- a compound semiconductor that is lattice mismatched relative to the initial layer and underlying layer is deposited on the initial layer.
- the lattice mismatch of the compound semiconductor is such that the growth forms three dimensional islands after a deposition of a critical thickness of the compound semiconductor.
- the three dimensional islands of the emission substructure are formed such that they are aligned with the self-assembled QDs of the underlying template structure.
- the growth is continued to allow the three dimensional islands to expand to form the self-assembled QDs that have the desired characteristic dimensional range.
- the deposition of the analog-graded QW material resumes such that the self-assembled QDs are covered and fully embedded within the analog-graded QW of the respective emission structure.
- the size of the QDs of the template and emission substructures can dictate the wavelength of the electromagnetic radiation emitted or absorbed for the desired optical function (laser emission, amplification, optical detection).
- the size of the QDs of the template and emission substructures can be controlled to dictate the emission/absorption wavelength in range from 1300 nm up to 1550 nm for use in the O to L (1260-1625 nm) bands employed in commercial optical telecommunication networks.
- the characteristic emission/absorption wavelengths can be different for QDs of the template and emission substructures for the QD-in-QW structures 1019 and 1023 , respectively.
- the size of the QDs of the template and emission substructures for the QD-in-QW structure 1019 can be controlled to dictate the emission/absorption wavelength in range near 1310 nm
- the size of the QDs of the template and emission substructures for the QD-in-QW structure 1023 can be controlled to dictate the emission/absorption wavelength in range near 1550 nm.
- the density distribution of the QDs of the template and emission substructures dictates the laser output power.
- a high density of embedded QDs can provide for an increase of laser output power, but require a greater threshold lasing current.
- the density distribution of the QDs of the template substructures dictates the density distribution of the QDs of the adjacent emission substructure and allows the growth conditions of the emission substructure to be tuned to control the size of the QDs of the adjacent emission substructure.
- the template substructure relaxes the strain mismatch of the emission substructure that arises from the layer underlying the template substructure and thus allows for the larger sized QDs to be assembled in the adjacent emission substructure.
- FIGS. 11A-F collectively, illustrate an exemplary layer structure utilizing group III-V materials for realizing the device structure of FIG. 10 as described herein.
- the layer structure of FIGS. 11A-F can be made, for example, using known molecular beam epitaxy (MBE) techniques.
- MBE molecular beam epitaxy
- a semiconductor layer 1103 of aluminum arsenide (AlAs) and a semiconductor layer 1105 of gallium arsenide (GaAs) are alternately deposited (with preferably at least seven pairs) upon a semi-insulating GaAs substrate 1101 in sequence to form the bottom DBR mirror layers.
- AlAs aluminum arsenide
- GaAs gallium arsenide
- the number of AlAs layers will preferably always be one greater than the number of GaAs layers so that the first and last layers of the mirror are shown as layer 1103 .
- the AlAs layers 1103 are subjected to high temperature steam oxidation during fabrication to produce the compound Al x O y so that a mirror will be formed at the designed center wavelength. This center wavelength is selected such that all of the desired resonant wavelengths for the device structures will be subject to high reflectivity.
- the thicknesses of layers 1103 and 1105 in the mirror can be chosen so that the final optical thickness of GaAs and Al x O y are one quarter wavelength of the center wavelength ⁇ C .
- the mirrors could be grown as alternating layers of one-quarter wavelength thickness of GaAs and AlAs at the designed wavelength so that the oxidation step is not used. In that case, many more pairs are required (with typical numbers such as 27.5 pairs) to achieve the reflectivity needed for efficient optical lasing and detection.
- the layers 1103 and 1105 correspond to the bottom DBR mirror layers 1003 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- the substrate 1101 corresponds to the substrate 1001 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- the metamorphic buffer that significantly reduces strain due lattice mismatch between the overlying active device structure of InGaAs material as described herein and the underlying bottom DBR mirror layers and the GaAs substrate 1101 .
- the metamorphic buffer accommodates lattice mismatch between the underlying structure (bottom DBR mirror layers 1003 and substrate 1001 ) and the overlying structure (the alloys of the active device structure) and absorbs strain due to such lattice mismatch while minimizing the nucleation of dislocations.
- the metamorphic buffer begins with a buffer layer 1107 of undoped GaAs having a typical thickness of 34 ⁇ .
- a super-lattice 1109 of Al y1 Ga (1-y1) As and GaAs are alternately deposited (with preferably at least five pairs) on the buffer layer 1107 .
- Al y1 Ga 1-y1) As is an alloy of AlAs and GaAs where the parameter y1 is the proportion of AlAs and (1-y1) is the proportion of GaAs.
- the parameter y1 is preferably at or near 50% (more preferably at 52%) for the super-lattice 1109 .
- the Al y1 Ga (1-y1) As layers and the GaAs layers of the super-lattice 1109 have a typical thickness of 2.4 ⁇ and 1.4 ⁇ , respectively.
- a layer 1111 of In x1 Al (1-x1) As is deposited on the super-lattice 1109 .
- In x1 Al (1-x1) As is an alloy of InAs and AlAs where the parameter x1 is the proportion of InAs and (1-x1) is the proportion of AlAs.
- the parameter x1 is preferably graded in an analog manner from 5% to 28% for layer 1111 .
- the In x1 Al (1-x1) As layer 1111 has a typical thickness of 340 ⁇ . The grading is carried out in the growth direction for all graded layers of FIGS. 11A-11F .
- the substrate temperature is controlled to a temperate preferably at or near 600° C. when depositing layers 1102 to 1109 .
- an inverse step layer 1113 of In x1 Al (1-x1) As is deposited on layer 1111 .
- the parameter x1 is preferably graded in an analog manner from 28% to 25% for layer 1113 and thus layer 1113 matches layers 1111 at the interface between layers 1113 and 1111 .
- the In x1 Al (1-x1) As layer 1113 has a typical thickness of 20 ⁇ .
- the substrate temperature is controlled to a temperate preferably in the range of 400-450° C. when depositing layers 1111 to 1235 as described herein.
- a healing layer 1115 of In x1 Al (1-x1) As is deposited on layer 1113 .
- the parameter x1 is constant preferably at 25% for layer 1115 and thus layer 1115 matches layer 1113 at the interface between layers 1115 and 1113 .
- the In x1 Al (1-x1) As layer 1115 has a typical thickness of 120 ⁇ .
- a layer 1117 of In x1 Al (1-x1) As is deposited on layer 1115 .
- the parameter x1 is preferably graded in an analog manner from 25% to 52% for layer 1117 and thus layer 1117 matches layer 1115 at the interface between layers 1117 and 1115 .
- the In x1 Al (1-x1) As layer 1117 has a typical thickness of 380 ⁇ .
- an inverse step layer 1119 of In x1 Al (1-x1) As is deposited on layer 1117 .
- the parameter x1 is preferably graded in an analog manner from 52% to 49% for layer 1119 and thus layer 1119 matches layer 1117 at the interface between layers 1119 and 1117 .
- the In x1 Al (1-x1) As layer 1119 has a typical thickness of 20 ⁇ .
- a healing layer 1121 of In x1 Al (1-x1) As is deposited on layer 1119 .
- the parameter x1 is constant preferably at 49% for layer 1121 and thus layer 1121 matches layer 1119 at the interface between layers 1121 and 1119 .
- the In x1 Al (1-x1) As layer 1121 has a typical thickness of 110 ⁇ .
- the inverse step and healing layers of the metamorphic buffer provide a relatively abrupt change of strain in the respective inverse step layers and thus promotes isolated threading dislocations in the inverse step layers while reducing threading dislocations in the layers thereabove and thus provide smoother growing surfaces.
- the layers 1107 to 1121 corresponds to the metamorphic buffer 1005 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- a spacer layer 1123 of undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As is an alloy of InAs and GaAs where the parameter x1 is the proportion of InAs and (1-x1) is the proportion of GaAs.
- the parameter x1 is constant preferably at 53% for layer 1123 .
- the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As layer 1123 has a typical thickness of 200 ⁇ .
- the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As layer 1123 functions to eliminate anti-null absorption.
- the spacer layer 1123 corresponds to the spacer layer 1007 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- Spacer layer 1123 Deposited on spacer layer 1123 is the active device structure which begins with layer 1125 of N+ type In x1 Ga (1-x1) As that enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto.
- the parameter x1 is constant preferably at 53% for layer 1125 and thus layer 1125 matches spacer layer 1123 .
- Layer 1125 has a typical thickness near 3000 ⁇ and a typical n-type doping of 3.5 ⁇ 10 18 cm ⁇ 3 .
- the N+ doped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As layer 1125 corresponds to the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer 1009 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- the parameter x1 is preferably 52% for layer 1127 .
- the wideband material of layer 1125 serves as part of the gate region of the p-channel HFET device and optically as a small part of the lower waveguide cladding of the respective optical device. Note that a majority of the lower waveguide cladding for waves propagating in the guide formed by the optically active region of the device is provided by the lower DBR mirror itself.
- the first layer 1129 is a tertiary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As where the parameter x1 is preferably 53% and with a typical thickness of 12 ⁇ .
- the second layer 1131 is a quaternary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As.
- In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As is an alloy of InAs, AlAs and GaAs where the parameter x1 is the proportion of InAs, the parameter x2 is the proportion of AlAs and (1-x1-x2) is the proportion of GaAs.
- the parameters x1 and x2 for layer 1131 is preferably 53% and 21%, respectively, and layer 1131 has a typical thickness of 20 ⁇ .
- the third layer 1133 is a tertiary alloy of In x1 Ga (1-x1) As where the parameter x1 of layer 1133 is preferably 53% and with a typical thickness of 12 ⁇ .
- the fourth layer 1135 is a quaternary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As where the parameters x1, x2 of layer 1135 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively, and layer 1135 has a typical thickness of 80 ⁇ .
- the stack of layers 1129 , 1131 , 1133 , 1135 are mid-band gap materials and operate to trap defects from the Al material of layer 1131 .
- the n-type layers 1127 to 1135 correspond to the bottom n-type layer(s) 1011 of FIG. 10 .
- an undoped layer 1137 formed from a quaternary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As, where the parameters x1 and x2 of layer 1137 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.
- Layer 1137 has a typical thickness of 300 ⁇ .
- the undoped InAlGaAs layer 1137 corresponds to the spacer layer(s) 1013 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- a thin p-type charge sheet 1139 formed from a quaternary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As, where the parameters x1 and x2 of layer 1139 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.
- Layer 1139 is doped P+ with a typical p-type doping of 7 ⁇ 10 18 cm ⁇ 3 and has a typical thickness of 40 ⁇ .
- a undoped spacer layer 1141 formed from the quaternary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As, where the parameters x1 and x2 of layer 1141 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.
- Layer 1141 has a typical thickness of 30 ⁇ .
- an undoped InGaAs barrier layer 1143 and an InGaAs quantum well layer 1145 are repeated for a number of quantum wells (such as three or more quantum wells) for the inverted p-type modulation doped quantum structure.
- Single quantum well structures may also be used.
- the undoped InGaAs barrier layer 1143 is formed from a tertiary alloy of In x1 Ga (1-x1) As, where the parameter x1 is preferably 53%. Layer 1143 has a typical thickness of 15 ⁇ .
- the InGaAs quantum well layer 1145 is formed from a tertiary alloy of In x1 Ga (1-x1) As, where the parameter x1 is preferably 70%. Layer 1145 has a typical thickness of 60 ⁇ . Layers 1139 to 1145 correspond to the inverted p-type modulation doped quantum structure 1015 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- An undoped InGaAs layer 1147 follows the last InGaAs quantum well layer.
- the undoped InGaAs layer 1147 is formed from a tertiary alloy of In x1 Ga (1-x1) As, where the parameter x1 is preferably 53%.
- Layer 1147 has a typical thickness of 300-500 ⁇ .
- Layer 1147 corresponds to spacer layer 1017 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- layers 1149 to 1177 that correspond to the QD-in QW structure 1019 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- Layers 1149 to 1153 form the template QD structure with InAs QDs embedded within a non-graded In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well where the parameter x1 is 70%.
- the initial layer 1149 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1151 ) is preferably about 2 ⁇ thick.
- the layer 1153 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40-60 ⁇ thick.
- An undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1155 is deposited on the InGaAs quantum well layer 1153 .
- the parameter x1 of the undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1155 is preferably 53%.
- Layer 1155 has a typical thickness of 100 ⁇ .
- Layers 1157 to 1161 form the emission QD structure on the barrier layer 1155 .
- the emission QD structure includes InAs QDs embedded within an In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that employs analog grading of In content.
- the initial layer 1157 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40 ⁇ thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface to barrier layer 1155 to the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence.
- the layer 1161 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1159 ) is preferably about 40 ⁇ thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence to the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface to barrier layer 1163 .
- An undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1163 is deposited on the top InGaAs quantum well layer 1161 .
- the parameter x1 of the undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1163 is preferably 53%.
- the undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1163 is preferably about 300-500 ⁇ thick.
- barrier layer 1163 layers 1165 to 1169 that form the template QD structure with InAs QDs embedded within a non-graded In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well where the parameter x1 is 70%.
- the initial layer 1165 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1167 ) is preferably about 2 ⁇ thick.
- the layer 1169 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40-60 ⁇ thick.
- An undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1171 is deposited on the InGaAs quantum well layer 1169 .
- the parameter x1 of the undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1171 is preferably 53%.
- Layer 1171 has a typical thickness of 100 ⁇ .
- Layers 1173 to 1177 form the emission QD structure on the barrier layer 1171 .
- the emission QD structure includes InAs QDs embedded within an In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that employs analog grading of In content.
- the initial layer 1173 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40 ⁇ thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface to barrier layer 1175 to the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence.
- the layer 1177 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1175 ) is preferably about 40 ⁇ thick and has analog grading of In content from the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence to the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface to spacer layer 1179 .
- an undoped spacer layer 1179 formed from a quaternary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As, where the parameters x1 and x2 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.
- Layer 1179 has a typical thickness of 4000 ⁇ . Layer 1179 correspond to the spacer layer(s) 1021 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- Layer 1181 is an undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer preferably with the parameter x1 of 53% and with a thickness on the order of 300-500 ⁇ .
- Layers 1183 to 1187 fatal the template QD structure with InAs QDs embedded within a non-graded In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well where the parameter x1 is 70%.
- the initial layer 1183 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1185 ) is preferably about 2 ⁇ thick.
- the layer 1187 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40-60 ⁇ thick.
- An undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1189 is deposited on the InGaAs quantum well layer 1153 .
- the parameter x1 of the undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As InGaAs barrier layer 1189 is preferably 53%.
- Layer 1189 has a typical thickness of 100 ⁇ .
- Layers 1191 to 1195 form the emission QD structure on the barrier layer 1189 .
- the emission QD structure includes InAs QDs embedded within an In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that employs analog grading of In content.
- the initial layer 1191 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40 ⁇ thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface to barrier layer 1189 to the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence.
- the layer 1195 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40 ⁇ thick and has analog grading of In content from the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence to the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface to barrier layer 1197 .
- An undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1197 is deposited on the top InGaAs quantum well layer 1195 .
- the parameter x1 of the undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1197 is preferably 53%.
- the undoped InGaAs barrier layer 1197 is preferably about 300-500 ⁇ thick.
- barrier layer 1197 layers 1199 to 1203 that form the template QD structure with InAs QDs embedded within a non-graded In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well with the parameter x1 of 70%.
- the initial layer 1199 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1201 ) is preferably about 2 ⁇ thick.
- the layer 1203 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40-60 ⁇ thick.
- An undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1205 is deposited on the InGaAs quantum well layer 1203 .
- the parameter x1 of the undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1205 is preferably 53%.
- Layer 1205 has a typical thickness of 100 ⁇ .
- Layers 1207 to 1211 form the emission QD structure on the barrier layer 1205 .
- the emission QD structure includes InAs QDs embedded within an In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that employs analog grading of In.
- the initial layer 1207 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40 ⁇ thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface to barrier layer 1205 to the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence.
- the layer 1211 of the In x1 Ga (1-x1) As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1209 ) is preferably about 40 ⁇ thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence to the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface to barrier layer 1213 .
- An undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1213 is deposited on the InGaAs quantum well layer 1211 .
- the parameter x1 of the undoped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As barrier layer 1213 is preferably 53%.
- Layer 1213 has a typical thickness of 300-500 ⁇ and corresponds to the spacer layer 1025 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- the InGaAs quantum well layer 1215 is formed from a tertiary alloy of In x1 Ga (1-x1) As, where the parameter x1 is preferably 706%.
- Layer 1215 has a typical thickness of 60 ⁇ .
- the undoped InGaAs barrier layer 1217 is formed from a tertiary alloy of In x1 Ga (1-x1) As, where the parameter x1 is preferably 53%.
- Layer 1217 has a typical thickness of 15 ⁇ .
- a undoped spacer layer 1219 formed from a quaternary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As where the parameters x1 and x2 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.
- Layer 1219 has a typical thickness of 30 ⁇ .
- a thin n-type charge sheet 1221 formed from a quaternary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As, where the parameters x1 and x2 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.
- Layer 1221 is doped N+ with a typical n-type doping of 3.5 ⁇ 10 18 cm ⁇ 3 and has a typical thickness of 80 ⁇ .
- the layers 1215 to 1221 corresponds to the n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 1027 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- an undoped layer 1223 formed from a quaternary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As, where the parameters x1 and x2 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.
- Layer 11223 has a typical thickness of 300 ⁇ .
- the undoped InAl GaAs layer 1223 corresponds to the spacer layer(s) 1029 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- the first layer 1225 is a quaternary alloy of In x1 Al x2 Ga (1-x1-x2) As where the parameters x1 and x2 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.
- the first layer 1225 is P+ doped with a typical p-type doping of 7 ⁇ 10 18 cm ⁇ 3 and has a typical thickness of 60 ⁇ .
- the second layer 1227 is a tertiary alloy of In x1 Ga (1-x1) As where the parameter x1 is preferably 53%.
- the second layer 1227 is P+ doped with a typical p-type doping of 7 ⁇ 10 18 cm ⁇ 3 and has a typical thickness of 12 ⁇ .
- the third layer 1229 is a tertiary alloy of In x1 Al (1-x1) As where the parameter x1 is preferably 52%.
- the third layer 1229 is P doped with a typical p-type doping of 5 ⁇ 10 17 cm ⁇ 3 and has a typical thickness of 700 ⁇ .
- the wideband material of layer 1229 serves as part of the gate region of the n-channel HFET device and optically as upper waveguide cladding of the respective optical device.
- the n-type layers 1225 to 1229 correspond to the top n-type layer(s) 1031 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- layers 1231 and 1233 of P+ type In x1 Ga (1-x1) As that enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto.
- the parameter x1 of layers 1231 and 1233 is constant preferably at 53%.
- Layer 1231 has a typical thickness near 900 ⁇ and a typical p-type doping of 7 ⁇ 10 18 cm ⁇ 3 .
- Layer 1233 has a typical thickness near 60 ⁇ and a typical p-type doping of 1 ⁇ 10 20 cm ⁇ 3 .
- the P+ doped In x1 Ga (1-x1) As layers 1231 and 1233 corresponds to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1133 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- layer 1235 of undoped in x1 Ga (1-x1) As with a typical thickness of 700-1000 ⁇ (more preferably near 870 ⁇ ).
- the parameter x1 for layer 1233 is preferably 53%.
- Layer 1235 can be used to form an aperture for optical devices (such as VCSELs) as described herein and to form active and passive in-plane optical waveguide structures (such as the active and passive sections of the closed-path waveguides) as described herein.
- Layer 1233 corresponds to the optical guide layer 1035 of FIG. 10 as described above.
- the size of the embedded QDs of the template and emission substructures of the template and emission QD substructures contributes to the emission/absorption wavelength of such structures.
- the embedded QDs of the template and emission substructures have the following characteristics:
- the incorporation of In into the quantum wells of the n-type and p-type modulation doped quantum well structures can greatly improve the frequency response (i.e., higher cutoff frequencies) for transistor devices including the n-channel HFET and the p-channel HFET devices.
- FIGS. 12A to 12I illustrate exemplary fabrication steps that form an optical feature (such as an aperture) this is aligned to patterned metal and one mnore underlying implant regions as part of optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 10 .
- the optical feature is formed at the top surface of the layer structure of FIG. 10 .
- the optical feature can be an aperture that allows for light to exit or enter into the active region of the device.
- the patterned metal regions and one or more underlying implant regions can be used to block light from exiting or entering into the active region of the device structure and thus form the boundary of the aperture.
- Similar methodology can also be used to form a passive and/or active in-plane waveguide structures as part of optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 10 .
- Such in-plane waveguide guides the propagation of light in the plane of the integrated circuit, and the optical feature formed at the top surface provides for vertical confinement and wave guiding of light for the top portion of the integrated circuit wafer.
- the patterned metal can be omitted.
- a protective layer 1201 (preferably formed from silicon nitride) is deposited on the top surface of layer 1035 of FIG. 10 as shown in FIGS. 12A and 12B .
- a mask (preferably formed from photoresist material) is deposited and patterned to define a mask feature 1203 as shown in FIG. 12C .
- the mask feature 1203 protects the area of the aperture 1205 that results from the process as shown in FIG. 12I .
- mask feature 1203 is used as part of an etch operation that etches through the exposed protective layer 1201 and underlying guide layer 1035 to a depth at or near the top surface 1209 of layer 1033 , and thus leaving behind a post that includes the protective layer 1201 and underlying guide layer 1035 as shown in FIG. 12D .
- the post can include one or more sidewalls (such as the two opposed sidewalls 1207 A, 1207 B) that extend through the protective layer 1201 and underlying guide layer 1035 as shown.
- This etch operation can employ an anisotropic etching process that define a near vertical profile for the sidewall(s) of the post .
- An example of a suitable anisotropic etching process is dry reactive ion etching employing SF 6 .
- one or more implant regions such as two implant regions 1211 A, 1211 B) are implanted through the top surface 1209 into the layer structure outside the post as shown in FIG. 12E .
- the one or more implant regions e.g., regions 1211 A, 1211 B
- the one or more implant regions employ n-type species of sufficient density that convert the p-type implanted region to n-type and produce a pn junction that blocks the flow of hole current flow vertically downwards.
- the one or more implant regions can be implanted to a depth below the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 . This requires higher energy to place the implant region(s) below such QW(s).
- the one or more implant regions e.g., regions 1211 A, 1211 B
- the larger barrier means that p-type conduction over this barrier is reduced and so the hole current from the top contact flows laterally where the barrier is lower (i.e., the vertically down conduction is blocked) preferentially to the un-implanted active region of the device structure disposed below the post.
- the ions species of the implant region(s) can be Si ions due to its lower mass and larger possible range. SiF ions may also be used.
- the advantage of locating the current blocking implant region(s) below the QW of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027 is that the top p-type layers 1031 can be made thinner (preferably a 1/2 ⁇ above the QW), which makes it easier to fabricate HFETs with a lower profile topology.
- the implant region(s) can also provide for lateral confinement of light within the active region of the device structure disposed below the post.
- metal material 1213 for the top surface electrode which can be tungsten or some other suitable metal or metal alloy, is deposited and patterned such that it covers the top surface 1209 of layer 1033 and the top surface and sidewalls of the guide layer 1035 of the post as evident from FIG. 12F .
- a second mask layer 1215 (preferably formed from photoresist material) is deposited and patterned to define a window 1216 that overlies the metal feature 1213 and the guide layer 1035 of the post as shown in FIG. 12G .
- the window 1216 is used as part of an etch operation that etches down through the metal 1213 to a depth at or near the top surface of the guide layer 1035 in the area that results in the aperture 1205 .
- This etch operation can employ a BOE (Buffered Oxide Etch) that etches sideways and removes the top section of the exposed metal feature 1213 to form the resultant structure as shown in FIG. 12H .
- the second mask layer 1215 is then removed to form the structure as shown in 121 where the aperture 1205 is formed between the opposed surface electrode parts 1217 A, 1217 B.
- the current blocking implant region(s) e.g., implant regions 1211 A, 1211 B
- implant regions 1211 A, 1211 B are disposed on opposite sides of the aperture 1205 below the corresponding surface electrode parts 1217 A, 1217 B.
- the opposed edges of the implant regions 1211 A, 1211 B are generally aligned laterally with the opposed edges of the surface electrode parts 1217 A, 1217 B that define the boundaries of the aperture 1215 .
- This self-aligned configuration of the implant region(s) and the surface electrode is advantageous because it can eliminate fabrication steps, aid in minimizing resistance of the top surface layers and aid in producing uniformity and higher yield over large areas.
- similar methodology can be used to form a passive and/or active in-plane waveguide structures as part of optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of FIG. 10 .
- Such in-plane waveguide guides the propagation of light in the plane of the integrated circuit, and the waveguide layer of the post feature formed at the top surface provides for wave guiding of the in-plane propagating light at the top portion of the integrated circuit wafer.
- the patterned metal can be omitted.
- the surface electrode that defines the boundaries of the aperture 1205 can be patterned and etched away after metallizing all of the electrodes of the devices of the integrated circuit and prior to depositing the dielectric material of the top mirror of such device, if used.
Abstract
Description
- The present application claims priority from U.S. Prov. Appl. No. 61/962,303, filed on Jan. 29, 2014, herein incorporated by reference in its entirety.
- 1. Field
- The present application relates to semiconductor integrated circuits that implement a variety optoelectronic functions (such as optical emitters, optical detectors and optical switches) and electronic functions (such as heterojunction field effect transistors and bipolar field effect transistors).
- 2. State of the Art
- The present application builds upon technology (referred to by the Applicant as “Planar Optoelectronic Technology” or “POET”) that provides for the realization of a variety of devices (optoelectronic devices, logic circuits and/or signal processing circuits) utilizing inversion quantum-well channel device structures as described in detail in U.S. Pat. No. 6,031,243; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/556,285, filed on Apr. 24, 2000; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/798,316, filed on Mar. 2, 2001; International Application No. PCT/US02/06802 filed on Mar. 4, 2002; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 08/949,504, filed on Oct. 14, 1997, U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/200,967, filed on Jul. 23,2002; U.S. application Ser. No. 09/710,217, filed on Nov. 10,2000; U.S. Patent Application No. 60/376,238, filed on Apr. 26, 2002; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/323,390, filed on Dec. 19, 2002; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/280,892, filed on Oct. 25, 2002; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/323,390, filed on Dec. 19, 2002; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/323,513, filed on Dec. 19, 2002; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/323,389, filed on Dec. 19, 2002; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/323,388, filed on Dec. 19, 2002; U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/340,942, filed on Jan. 13, 2003; all of which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entireties.
- With these structures, a fabrication sequence can be used to make the devices on a common substrate. In other words, n type and p type contacts, critical etches, etc. can be used to realize all of these devices simultaneously on a common substrate. The essential features of this device structure include 1) an n-type modulation doped interface and a p-type modulation doped quantum well interface, 2) self-aligned n-type and p-type channel contacts formed by ion implantation, 3) n-type metal contacts to the n-type ion implants and the bottom n-type layer structure, and 4) p-type metal contacts to the p-type ion implants and the top p-type layer structure. The active device structures are preferably realized with a material system of group III-V materials (such as a GaAs/AlGaAs).
- POET can be used to construct a variety of optoelectronic devices. POET can also be used to construct a variety of high performance transistor devices, such as complementary NHFET and PHFET unipolar devices as well as n-type and p-type HBT bipolar devices.
- A semiconductor device employs an epitaxial layer arrangement including a first ohmic contact layer and first modulation doped quantum well structure disposed above the first ohmic contact layer. The first ohmic contact layer has a first doping type, and the first modulation doped quantum well structure has a modulation doped layer of a second doping type. At least one isolation ion implant region is provided that extends through the first ohmic contact layer. The at least one isolation ion implant region can include oxygen ions. The at least one isolation ion implant region can define a region that is substantially free of charge carriers in order to reduce a characteristic capacitance of the device.
- In one embodiment, the epitaxial layer arrangement further includes at least one spacer layer disposed above the first modulation doped quantum well structure. A mesa can be formed in the at least one spacer layer. At least one contact implant region can be disposed below the mesa in contact with the first modulation doped quantum well structure. At least one electrode terminal can be formed on the mesa in contact with the at least one contact implant region. The at least one isolation implant region can be disposed below the mesa and below the at least one contact implant region.
- In another embodiment, the first modulation doped quantum well structure defines a QW channel of an HFET device, wherein the QW channel extends between opposed contact ion implant regions that are in contact with corresponding source and drain terminal electrodes of the HFET device, and a gate terminal electrode of the HFET device is in contact with the first ohmic contact layer.
- In another embodiment, the first modulation doped quantum well structure defines a QW channel of a BICFET device, wherein the QW channel is in contact with a base terminal electrode of the BICFET device, and an emitter terminal electrode of the BICFET device is in contact with the first ohmic contact layer.
- In still another embodiment, the at least one isolation implant region provides for lateral confinement of light within a resonant cavity defined by the epitaxial layer arrangement.
- In yet another embodiment, the first modulation doped quantum well structure, the first ohmic contact layer and the at least one isolation implant region are all part of an optical resonator formed in the epitaxial layer arrangement, wherein the optical resonator is adapted to process light at at least one predetermined wavelength. The optical resonator can include a resonant cavity supporting propagation of an optical signal therein, wherein the at least one isolation implant is disposed adjacent the resonant cavity. A first terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the first modulation doped quantum well structure. A second terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the first ohmic contact layer. The first and second terminal electrodes can be configured as terminals of a diode laser whereby injected electrical current flows between the first and second terminal electrodes and causes light generation and propagation within the resonant cavity. Alternatively, the first and second terminal electrodes are configured as terminals of a diode optical detector that carry electrical current caused by absorption of light propagating within the resonant cavity.
- In another embodiment, the epitaxial layer arrangement can include at least one spacer layer disposed above the first modulation doped quantum well structure, a second modulation doped quantum well structure disposed above the at least one spacer layer, and a second ohmic contact layer disposed above the second modulation doped quantum well structure. The second modulation doped quantum well structure has a modulation doped layer of the first doping type, and the second ohmic contact layer has the second doping type. A top terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the second ohmic contact layer. A first injector terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the second modulation doped quantum well structure. A second injector terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the first modulation doped quantum well structure. A bottom terminal electrode can be formed in electrical contact with the first ohmic contact layer. The top terminal electrode, the first injector terminal electrode, the second injector terminal electrode, and the bottom teitninal electrode can be configured as terminals of a switching thyristor laser having an ON state whereby current flows between the top terminal electrode and bottom terminal electrode to cause light generation and propagation within the resonant cavity. Alternatively, the top terminal electrode, the first injector terminal electrode, the second injector terminal electrode, and the bottom terminal electrode can be configured as terminals of a switching thyristor optical detector having an ON state whereby current flows between the top terminal electrode and bottom terminal electrode, wherein the ON state is caused by absorption of light propagation in the resonant cavity.
- In such embodiments, the resonant cavity can have a disk-like shape and the optical signal comprises a whispering gallery optical signal, or the resonant cavity can have an annular-shape and the optical signal comprises a circulating optical signal. The at least one isolation implant region can be disposed adjacent a central region of the resonant cavity or adjacent a peripheral region of the resonant cavity.
- In another embodiment, the resonant cavity can be defined by a rib waveguide, wherein the at least one isolation implant region is disposed on at least one side of the rib waveguide. The rib waveguide can have a plurality of straight sections that are optically coupled together by bend sections. A coupling waveguide structure can be spaced from the resonant cavity of optical resonator to provide for evanescent-wave optical coupling therebetween.
- In one embodiment, the resonant cavity of the optical resonator and the coupling waveguide structure can be defined by sidewalls of the epitaxial layer arrangement. The epitaxial layer arrangement can be disposed above a bottom DBR mirror, wherein the sidewalls that define the resonant cavity of the optical resonator and the coupling waveguide structure extend downward to the bottom DBR mirror.
- In one embodiment, the epitaxial layer arrangement includes an N+ type doped layer for the first ohmic contact layer, a first plurality of layers that define a p-type modulation doped quantum well structure for the first modulation doped quantum well structure, a second plurality of layers that define an n-type modulation doped quantum well structure for the second n-type modulation doped structure, and a P+ type doped layer for the second ohmic contact layer.
- In another aspect, a semiconductor device includes a dual-cavity optical resonator having a first vertical resonant cavity surrounded by a second annular resonant cavity formed in an epitaxial layer arrangement. A coupling waveguide structure is spaced from the second resonant cavity of optical resonator to provide for evanescent-wave optical coupling therebetween. The second resonant cavity of the optical resonator and the coupling waveguide structure can be defined by sidewalls of the epitaxial layer arrangement. The coupling waveguide structure and the optical resonator can be configured to perform predetermined mode transformation operations selected from the group consisting of vertical propagation to in-plane propagation, in-plane propagation to vertical propagation, wavelength conversion, and combinations thereof.
- In one embodiment, the epitaxial layer arrangement includes a first ohmic contact layer, a first modulation doped quantum well structure disposed above the first ohmic contact layer, at least one spacer layer disposed above the first modulation doped quantum well structure, a second modulation doped quantum well structure disposed above the spacer layer, and a second ohmic contact layer disposed above the second modulation doped quantum well structure, wherein the first ohmic contact layer has a first doping type, the first modulation doped quantum well structure has a modulation doped layer of a second doping type, the second first modulation doped quantum well structure has a modulation doped layer of the first doping type, and the second ohmic contact layer has the second doping type. The dual cavity resonator can include a top terminal electrode in electrical contact with the second ohmic contact layer, at least one of a first injector terminal electrode s (which is in electrical contact with the second modulation doped quantum well structure) and a second injector terminal (which is in electrical contact with the first modulation doped quantum well structure), and a bottom terminal electrode in electrical contact with the first ohmic contact layer. The electrodes of the device can be configured as terminals of a switching thyristor laser having an ON state whereby current flows between the top terminal electrode and bottom terminal electrode causes light generation and propagation within the vertical resonant cavity. Alternatively, the electrodes of the device are configured as terminals of a switching thyristor optical detector having an ON state whereby current flows between the top terminal electrode and bottom terminal electrode, wherein the ON state is caused by absorption of light propagating in the vertical resonant cavity.
- In yet another aspect, a semiconductor device includes an optical resonator including a closed path waveguide that supports circulating propagation of light. A waveguide structure is spaced from the closed path waveguide of the optical resonator to provide for evanescent-wave optical coupling therebetween. The closed path waveguide includes at least one active section and a tuning section that is isolated from the at least one active section. The active section is configured to generate or absorb light that circulates in the closed path waveguide. The tuning section is configured to provide electrical control of the wavelength of the light circulating in the closed path waveguide. The closed path waveguide of the optical resonator and the waveguide structure can both be formed in an epitaxial layer structure that includes at least one modulation doped quantum well structure. The tuning section of the closed path waveguide can include a plurality of electrodes for supplying electrical signals that control charge in one or more quantum wells of the at least one modulation doped quantum well structure of the tuning section in order to control the wavelength of the light circulating in the closed path waveguide. The tuning section of the closed path waveguide can be isolated from the at least one active section by passive waveguide sections.
- In yet another aspect, a semiconductor device includes an optical resonator having a closed path waveguide that supports circulating propagation of light. A waveguide structure is spaced from the closed path waveguide of the optical resonator to provide for evanescent-wave optical coupling therebetween. The waveguide structure has a first end disposed opposite a second end. A reflector structure is integral to the first end of the waveguide structure. The reflector structure includes a Bragg-grating that is configured to reflect a particular wavelength of light. The reflector structure can include two co-planar radio-frequency (RF) traveling wave transmission lines disposed on opposite sides of the Bragg-grating along the length of the Bragg-grating. A signal source can be configured to supply a traveling wave RF signal to the two co-planar RF traveling wave transmission lines in order to selectively vary the particular wavelength of light that is reflected by the Bragg-grating of the reflector structure. The closed path waveguide of the optical resonator and the waveguide structure and the reflector structure can all be formed in an epitaxial layer structure that includes at least one layer disposed above a modulation doped quantum well structure, The Bragg-grating can be formed in the at least one layer disposed above the modulation doped quantum well structure.
- In yet another aspect, a method is provided for forming a patterned layer of metal that defines an aperture of an optoelectronic device that is part of integrated circuit wafer. The method includes depositing and patterning a first mask on a top surface of the wafer, wherein the pattern of the first mask defines a feature that protects an area of the aperture. An ion implant operation is performed that forms at least one implant region adjacent the aperture. Metal is deposited such that the metal covers the top surface and the mask feature. A second mask is deposited and patterned to define a window that overlies the mask feature. The window has a smaller width that width of the mask feature. A first etch operation is performed that etches through the window defined by the second mask to a depth at or near the top surface. The first etch operation leaves being at least one sidewall of the mask feature. A second etch operation is performed that etches sideways and undercuts the at least one opposed sidewall of the mask feature as well as at least one adjacent sidewall of the metal to form the aperture. The first mask can be a dual layer structure of oxide and nitride. The second mask can be a photoresist material. The at least one ion implant region can provide for current funneling toward an active region under the aperture and/or lateral confinement of light within the active region under the aperture.
- In one embodiment, the metal comprises tungsten. The sidewall(s) that result from the first etch operation can have a width dimension on the order of 1-2 μm. The first etch operation can employ an anisotropic etching process that define a near vertical profile for the sidewall(s). The second etch operation can employ a buffer-oxide etchant.
- In another aspect, an optoelectronic semiconductor device includes a substrate and an epitaxial layer arrangement formed on the substrate. The epitaxial layer arrangement includes a buffer structure and an active device structure formed on the buffer structure. The active device structure includes at least one modulation doped quantum well structure spaced from a QD-in-QW structure. The buffer structure comprises a plurality of layer that are configured to accommodate lattice strain due to mismatch between the active device structure and the substrate.
- In one embodiment, the substrate is a GaAs substrate, the at least one modulation doped quantum well structure includes at least one InGaAs quantum well formed from an alloy of InAs and GaAs that includes at least 70 percent InAs, and the QD-in-QW structure includes quantum dots formed from InAs and embedded within at least one InGaAs quantum well formed from an alloy of InAs and GaAs that includes at least 70 percent InAs. The InGaAs quantum well of the QD-in-QW structure can include a template substructure formed below an emission substructure. The template substructure includes a non-graded InGaAs quantum well formed from an alloy of InAs and GaAs that includes less than 70 percent InAs, and the emission substructure includes a graded InGaAs quantum well formed from an alloy of InAs and GaAs that has a maximum percentage of InAs of at least 70 percent InAs. The buffer structure can include a plurality of layers formed from an alloy of InAs and AlAs and possibly a periodic superlattice layer structure comprising a first layer formed from an alloy of AlAs and GaAs and a second layer formed from GaAs.
- In another aspect, a method of fabricating an optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit wafer that includes a top layer overlying a doped ohmic contact layer and semiconductor layers therebelow. The method includes depositing a protective layer on the top layer, and depositing and patterning a first mask on the protective layer, wherein the pattern of the first mask protects an area for an optical feature. A first etch operation is performed that etches down to the doped ohmic contact in order to define the optical feature that includes the top layer. The first etch operation exposes the doped ohmic contact layer on at least one side of the optical feature and leaves behind at least one sidewall of the optical feature. An ion implant operation is performed that forms at least one ion implant region in the semiconductor layers disposed below the exposed doped ohmic contact layer and adjacent the at least one side of the optical feature. A second mask is deposited and patterned to define a window that overlies the optical feature. A second etch operation is performed that uses the window of the second mask to expose the top layer of the optical feature.
- In one embodiment, the optical feature is selected from group consisting of an aperture, a waveguide layer of an active waveguide structure, and a waveguide layer of a passive waveguide structure.
- The method can further include depositing metal such that the metal covers the optical feature. In this case, the second mask is deposited on the metal and the window defined by the second mask exposes metal that covers the optical feature, and the second etch operation removes the metal that covers the optical feature in order to expose the top layer of the optical feature.
- In one embodiment, the optical feature is selected from group consisting of an aperture, a waveguide layer of an active waveguide structure, and a waveguide layer of a passive waveguide structure. The top layer can comprise an undoped semiconductor layer. The protective layer can comprise a silicon nitride layer. The first etch operation can employ an anisotropic etching process that define a near vertical profile for the at least one sidewall of the optical feature. The second etch operation can employ a buffer-oxide etchant.
-
FIG. 1 is a schematic illustration of exemplary layer structures of the optoelectronic integrated circuit device structures ofFIGS. 2A to 9D . -
FIGS. 2A-2B illustrate a diode whispering gallery microresonator realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 ; -
FIG. 2A is a schematic top view of the diode whispering gallery microresonator; and -
FIG. 2B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the diode thyristor whispering gallery microresonator along the section labeled 2B-2B ofFIG. 2A . -
FIG. 3A-3B illustrate a diode ring microresonator realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 ;FIG. 3A is a schematic top view of the diode ring microresonator; andFIG. 3B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the diode ring microresonator along the section labeled 3B-3B ofFIG. 3A . -
FIGS. 4A-4B illustrate a thyristor whispering gallery microresonator realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 ;FIG. 4A is a schematic top view of the thyristor whispering gallery microresonator; andFIG. 4B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the thyristor whispering gallery microresonator along the section labeled 4B-4B ofFIG. 4A . -
FIGS. 5A-5E illustrates an embodiment of a closed-loop (rectangular path) microresonator realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 ;FIG. 5A is a schematic top view of the closed-loop microresonator;FIG. 5B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the closed-loop microresonator along the section labeled 5B-5B ofFIG. 5A ;FIG. 5C is a schematic cross-sectional view of the closed-loop microresonator along the section labeled 5C-5C ofFIG. 5A ;FIG. 5D is a schematic cross-sectional view of the closed-loop microresonator along the section labeled 5D-5D ofFIG. 5A ; andFIG. 5E is a schematic cross-sectional view of the closed-loop microresonator along the section labeled 5E-5E ofFIG. 5A . -
FIGS. 5F-5H illustrates an embodiment of a closed-loop (rectangular path) microresonator and electrically-controlled tuning reflector that are realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 ;FIG. 5F is a schematic top view of the closed-loop microresonator and electrically-controlled tuning reflector;FIG. 5G is a schematic cross-sectional view of the tuning reflector along the section labeled 5G-5GB ofFIG. 5F ; andFIG. 5H is a cross-section through the tuning reflector along the section labeled 5H-5H ofFIG. 5F . -
FIGS. 6A-6C illustrate an embodiment of a split-electrode vertical cavity surface emitting device realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 ;FIG. 6A is a schematic top view of the split-electrode vertical cavity surface emitting device;FIG. 6B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the split-electrode vertical cavity surface emitting device along the section labeled 6B-6B ofFIG. 6A ; andFIG. 6C is a schematic cross-sectional view of the split-electrode vertical cavity surface emitting device along the section labeled 6C-6C ofFIG. 6A . -
FIGS. 7A to 7C illustrate an embodiment of a p-channel HFET device realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 ;FIG. 7A is a schematic top view of the p-channel HFET device;FIG. 7B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the p-channel HFET device along the section labeled 7B-7B ofFIG. 7A ; andFIG. 7C is a schematic cross-sectional view of the p-channel HFET device along the section labeled 7C-7C ofFIG. 7A . -
FIGS. 8A to 8C illustrates a dual-wavelength hybrid device realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 ;FIG. 8A is a schematic top view of the dual-wavelength hybrid device;FIG. 8B is a schematic cross-sectional view of the dual-wavelength hybrid device along the section labeled 8B-8B ofFIG. 8A ; andFIG. 8C is a schematic cross-sectional view of the dual-wavelength hybrid device along the section labeled 8C-8C ofFIG. 8A . -
FIGS. 9A to 9D illustrate exemplary fabrication steps that form dopant implant regions that are self-aligned to patterned metal as part of an optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit wafer that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . -
FIG. 10 is a schematic illustration of another exemplary layer structure for realizing the optoelectronic integrated circuit device structures described herein. -
FIGS. 11A to 11F , collectively, are a chart illustrating an exemplary layer structure for realizing the optoelectronic integrated circuit device structures described herein. -
FIGS. 12A to 12I illustrate exemplary fabrication steps that form an aperture (or in-plane waveguide) in conjunction with patterned metal electrodes and/or aligned implant regions as part of an optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 10 . - Turning now to
FIG. 1 , the device structure of the present application includes a bottom dielectric distributed Bragg reflector (DBR)mirror 12 formed onsubstrate 10. Thebottom DBR mirror 12 is typically formed by depositing pairs of semiconductor or dielectric materials with different refractive indices. When two materials with different refractive indices are placed together to form a junction, light will be reflected at the junction. The amount of light reflected at one such boundary is small. However, if multiple junctions/layer pairs are stacked periodically with each layer having a quarter-wave (λ/4) optical thickness, the reflections from each of the boundaries will be added in phase to produce a large amount of reflected light (e.g., a large reflection coefficient) at the particular center wavelength λC. Deposited upon thebottom DBR mirror 12 is the active device structure suitable for realizing complementary heterostructure field-effect transistor (HFET) devices. The first of these complementary HFET devices is a p-channel HFET which has a p-type modulation doped quantum well (QW)structure 20 with an n-type gate region (i.e., n-typeohmic contact layer 14 and n-type layer(s) 16)) below the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. Anundoped spacer layer 18 is disposed between the p-type modulation doped quantum well (QW)structure 20 and the underlying n-type layer(s) 16. One or more spacer layers 22 are disposed above the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. The spacer layers 22 can include a first QD-In-QW structure (not shown) formed above the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20, where the first QD-In-QW structure includes at least one QW layer with self-assembled quantum dots (QDs) embedded therein. The first QD-In-QW structure can be spaced from the QW(s) of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 by an undoped spacer layer therebetween. The second of these complementary HFET devices is an n-channel HFET which includes an n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 with a p-type gate region (i.e., p-type layer(s) 28 and p-type ohmic contact 30) formed above the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24. Anundoped spacer layer 26 is disposed between the n-type modulation doped quantum well (QW)structure 24 and the overlying p-type layer(s) 28. The spacer layers 22 can also include a second QD-In-QW structure (not shown) formed below the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24, where the second QD-In-QW structure includes at least one QW layer with self-assembled quantum dots (QDs) embedded therein. The second QD-In-QW structure can be spaced from the QW(s) of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 by an undoped spacer layer therebetween. The layers encompassing thespacer layer 22 and the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 forms the collector region of the p-channel HFET. Similarly, the layers encompassing thespacer layer 22 and the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 forms the collector region of the n-channel HFET. Such collector regions are analogous to the substrate region of a MOSFET device as is well known. Therefore a non-inverted n-channel HFET device is stacked upon an inverted p-channel HFET device as part of the active device structure. - The active device layer structure begins with n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 which enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto. Deposited on
layer 14 are one or more n-type layers 16 and anundoped spacer layer 18 which serve electrically as part of the gate of the p-channel HFET device and optically as a part of the lower waveguide cladding of the device. Deposited onlayer 18 is the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 that defines a p-type charge sheet offset from one or more QWs (which may be formed from strained or unstrained heterojunction materials) by an undoped spacer layer. The p-type charge sheet is formed first below the undoped spacer and the one or more QWs of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. All of the layers grown thus far form the p-channel HFET device with the gate ohmic contact on the bottom. Deposited on the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 is one or more spacer layers 22. The spacer layers 22 can include first and QD-In-QW structures (not shown) that correspond to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 and the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24, respectively, and are offset from the corresponding structure by a respective undoped spacer layer. - Deposited on the spacer layer(s) 22 is the n-type modulation doped
QW structure 24. The n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 defines an n-type charge sheet offset from one or more QWs by an undoped spacer layer. The n-type charge sheet is formed last above the undoped spacer and the one or more QWs of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24. - Deposited on the n-type modulation doped
QW structure 24 is anundoped spacer layer 26 and one or more p-type layers 28 which can serve electrically as part of the gate of the n-channel HFET and optically as part of the upper waveguide cladding of the device. Preferably, the p-type layers 28 include two sheets of planar doping of highly doped p-material separated by a lightly doped layer of p-material. These p-type layers are offset from the n-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 24 by theundoped spacer layer 26. In this configuration, the top charge sheet achieves low gate contact resistance and the bottom charge sheet defines the capacitance of the n-channel HFET with respect to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24. Deposited on p-type layer(s) 28 is one or more p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30, which enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto. - For the n-channel HFET device, a gate terminal electrode (not shown) of the n-channel HFET device is operably coupled to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30. A source terminal electrode (not shown) and a drain terminal electrode (not shown) of the n-channel HFET device are operably coupled to opposite ends of a QW channel(s) realized in the n-type modulation doped
QW structure 24. One or more terminal electrodes (not shown) can be operably coupled to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 and used as collector terminal electrodes for the n-channel HFET device. - An exemplary embodiment of the p-channel HFET device is shown in
FIGS. 7A-7C , which includes a gate terminal electrode (G), a source terminal electrode (S), a drain terminal electrode (D), and a collector terminal electrode (Coll). The source terminal electrode (S) and the drain terminal electrode (D) are operably coupled to opposite sides of an elongate QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. The layer structure of the p-channel HFET device is patterned and etched down tospacer layer 22 to form atop mesa 711 atspacer layer 22 for the collector electrode (Coll). - The resulting structure is then patterned and etched to form opposed
elongate mesas spacer layer 22 above the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. Theelongate mesas FIGS. 7A and 7B . - A sequence of two different ion implant operations is then carried out to implant ions through the
elongate mesas ion implant regions 719 that create the self-aligned p-type contacts to the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20 that forms the QW channel of the p-channel HFET device. This implant can also possibly be accompanied by an implant of fluorine ions to prevent upward diffusion. A rapid thermal anneal (RTA) oxide is then deposited on the resultant structure and RTA operations are carried (for example, at 850° C. for 10 seconds) to activate theimplant regions 719. After the RTA is complete, a second implant operation is carried out involving oxygen ions to form high resistance deep oxygenion implant regions 721 in the bottomn+ contact layer 14, where such high resistance effectively blocks current flow therethrough. The peak density of the oxygenion implant regions 721 can be controlled to provide the desired resistance. In one embodiment, the peak density of the oxygenion implant regions 721 is at or near 1e19 cm-3. Multiple implants of oxygen ions at different energies can be used to provide complete coverage of the thickness of the bottomn+ contact layer 14. An RTA is then performed (preferably at 500° C. for about 15 seconds) in order to activate the oxygenion implant regions 721. Note that theimplant regions source mesa 713 and thedrain mesa 715 as best shown inFIG. 7B and extend parallel to the QW channel under the collector terminal electrode (Coll) along the lengthwise dimension of the QW channel on opposite sides of the QW channel. The current blocking oxygenion implant regions 721 define an isolation region between the p-type implant regions 719 and the bottom N+-typeohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure. Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the source terminal electrode (S) and the gate terminal electrode (G). This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the PHFET device if not reduced. Note the temperature (e.g., 500° C.) of the rapid thermal anneal operation that activates the oxygen ions of theimplant regions 721 can be significantly less than the temperature (e.g., 850° C.) of the rapid thermal anneal operation that activates the ions of theimplant regions 719. - The resulting structure is then etched to form a
mesa 723 at the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 for the gate terminal electrode (G) as best shown inFIG. 7C . - The metal that defines the elongate collector terminal electrode (Coll), which is preferably a W-In alloy, is deposited and patterned on the
top mesa 711 above the elongate QW channel in contact with thespacer layer 22. The metal of the collector terminal electrode (Coll) can have a wide tab-region 709 offset laterally from the source and drain terminal electrodes as best shown inFIG. 7A . The metal of the source and drain terminal electrodes (S) and (D), which is preferably an Au—Be alloy, is deposited and patterned on themesas ion implant regions 719 in order to contact the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 that forms the QW channel of the p-channel device as best shown inFIG. 7B . The metal of the gate terminal electrode (G), which is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy, is deposited and patterned on themesa 723 in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 as best shown inFIG. 7C . The resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the source, drain and gate electrodes as desired. In one embodiment, the resultant structure can be heated at 420° C. to treat the metal alloys of the source, drain, gate and collector electrodes of the device. - Both the n-channel HFET device and the p-channel HFET device are field effect transistors where current flows as a two-dimensional gas through a QW channel with contacts at either end. The basic transistor action is the modulation of the QW channel conductance by a modulated electric field that is perpendicular to the QW channel. The modulated electric field modulates the QW channel conductance by controlling an inversion layer (i.e., a two-dimensional electron gas for the n-channel HFET device or a two-dimensional hole gas for the p-channel HFET) as a function of gate voltage relative to source voltage.
- For the n-channel HFET device, the QW channel conductance is turned on by biasing the gate terminal electrode and the source terminal electrode at voltages where the P/N junction of the gate and source regions is forward biased with minimal gate conduction and an inversion layer of electron gas is created in the QW channel of the n-type modulation doped
quantum well structure 24 between the source terminal electrode and the drain terminal electrode. In this configuration, the source terminal electrode is the terminal electrode from which the electron carriers enter the QW channel of the n-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 24, the drain terminal electrode is the terminal electrode where the electron carriers leave the device, and the gate terminal electrode is the control terminal for the device. - The p-channel HFET device of
FIGS. 7A-7C operates in a similar manner to the n-channel HFET device with the current direction and voltage polarities reversed with respect to those of the n-channel HFET device. For the p-channel HFET device, the QW channel conductance is turned on by biasing the gate terminal electrode (G) and the source terminal electrode (S) at a voltage where the P/N junction of the source and gate regions is forward-biased with minimal gate conduction and an inversion layer of hole gas is created in the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20 between the source terminal electrode (S) and the drain terminal electrode (S). In this configuration, the source terminal electrode (S) is the terminal from which the hole carriers enter the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20, the drain terminal electrode (D) is the terminal where the hole carriers leave the device, and the gate terminal electrode (G) is the control terminal for the device. - The device structure of the present application can also be configured to realize bipolar inversion channel field-effect transistors (BICFETs) with either an n-type modulation doped quantum well inversion channel base region (n-channel base BICFET) or a p-type modulation doped quantum well inversion channel base region (p-channel base BICFET).
- For the n-channel base BICFET device, an emitter terminal electrode (not shown) of the n-channel base BICFET device is operably coupled to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30 of the active device structure. A base terminal electrode (not shown) of the n-channel base BICFET device is operably coupled to the QW channel(s) realized in the n-type modulation doped
QW structure 24. A collector terminal electrode (not shown) of the n-channel base BICFET device is operably coupled to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. The n-channel base BICFET device is a bipolar junction type transistor which can be operated in an active mode by applying a forward bias to the PN junction of the emitter and base regions while applying a reverse bias to the PN junction of the base and collector regions, which causes holes to be injected from the emitter terminal electrode to the collector terminal electrode. Because the holes are positive carriers, their injection contributes to current flowing out of the collector terminal electrode as well as current flowing into the emitter terminal electrode. The bias conditions also cause electrons to be injected from the base to the emitter, which contributes to current flowing out of the base terminal electrode as well as the current flowing into the emitter terminal electrode. - The p-channel base BICFET device is similar in construction to the p-channel HFET device of
FIGS. 7A-7C with the following adaptations. An emitter terminal electrode of the p-channel base BICFET device, which is analogous to the gate terminal electrode of the p-channel HFET device, is operably coupled to the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 of the active device structure. A base terminal electrode of the p-channel base BICFET device, which is analogous to the source or drain electrode of the p-channel HFET device, is operably coupled to the QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. A collector terminal electrode of the p-channel base BICFET device, which is analogous to the collector terminal electrode of the p-channel HFET device, is operably coupled to thespacer layer 22. The p-channel base BICFET device is a bipolar junction type transistor which can be operated in an active mode by applying a forward bias to the PN junction of the emitter and base regions while applying a reverse bias to the PN junction of the base and collector regions, which causes electrons to be injected from the emitter terminal electrode to the collector terminal electrode. Because the electrons are negative carriers, their injection contributes to current flowing into the collector terminal electrode as well as current flowing out of the emitter terminal electrode. The bias conditions also cause holes to be injected from the base to the emitter, which contributes to current flowing into the base terminal electrode as well as the current flowing out of the emitter terminal electrode. - The device structure of the present application can also be configured to realize optoelectronic devices such as an electrically-pumped laser or optical detector. To form a resonant cavity device for optical signal emission and/or detection, a top mirror can be formed over the active device structure described above. The top mirror can be formed by depositing pairs of semiconductor or dielectric materials with different refractive indices.
- In one configuration, the resonant cavity of the device can be configured as a vertical cavity and light may enter and exit the vertical cavity through an optical aperture (not shown) in the top surface of the device such that the device operates as a vertical cavity surface emitting laser/detector. In this configuration, the distance between the top mirror and the
bottom DBR mirror 12 represents the length of the optical cavity and can be set to correspond to the designated wavelength (such as 1 to 3 times the designated wavelength). This distance can take into account the penetration depth of the light into the bottom and top mirror. This distance is controlled by adjusting the thickness of one or more of the layers therebetween to enable this condition. - In another configuration, the resonant cavity of the device can be configured as a whispering gallery or closed-loop microresonator to support propagation of an optical mode signal within a waveguide region formed from the device structure. For the whispering gallery microresonator, the waveguide region can be a disk-like structure that supports propagation of a whispering gallery mode. The geometry of the disk-like structure is tuned to the particular wavelength of the whispering gallery mode. For example, the circumference of the disk-like structure can be configured to correspond to an integral number of wavelengths of a standing wave that circulates in the disk-like structure. For relatively small disk-like structures (e.g., 10 μm in diameter or less), the free spectral range FSR is large enough such that the diameter of the disk-like structure can dictate the particular wavelength of the whispering gallery mode. For the closed-loop microresonator, the waveguide can support circulating propagation of an optical mode that follows a circular optical path, a rectangular optical path, an oval optical path, or other suitable geometry. The optical path length of the closed-loop waveguide is tuned to the particular wavelength of the optical mode signal that is to propagate in the closed-loop waveguide. At least one coupling waveguide is formed integral to and adjacent the whispering gallery or closed-loop microresonator. The coupling waveguide provides for evanescent coupling of light to and/or from the whispering gallery or closed-loop microresonator. Specifically, for the laser, the whispering gallery mode produced by the whispering gallery microresonator or the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator is coupled to the coupling waveguide to produce an output optical signal that propagates in the coupling waveguide for output therefrom. For the detector, an input optical light is supplied to the coupling waveguide, which couples the input optical light as a whispering gallery mode in the whispering gallery microresonator for detection or as an optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator for detection.
- In the vertical cavity surface emitting laser/detector as well as the whispering gallery or closed-loop microresonator, an anode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30, and a cathode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the n-type modulation doped
QW structure 24. One or more optional electrodes can be operably coupled to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 as well as to the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14. If present, these optional electrodes are configured to float electrically with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode. In this manner, the p-type region of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode. Electrically, this configuration operates as an electrically-pumped diode laser or diode detector. This configuration is referred to herein as the top diode laser or top diode detector because the anode terminal electrode is operably coupled to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30 and the cathode terminal electrode is operably coupled to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24. - For the top diode laser, the anode terminal electrode is forward biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode such that holes are injected from the anode terminal electrode into the QW channel(s) realized in the n-type modulation doped
QW structure 24 in order to induce photon emission within the device structure. The lower p-type region of the active device structure (which includes the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode. For the vertical cavity surface emitting laser, the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode that is emitted vertically through the top surface of the device structure. For the whispering gallery microresonator, the photon emission within the device structure produces the whispering gallery mode signal that circulates in the waveguide of the whispering gallery microresonator. For the closed-loop microresonator, the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator. In all of these configurations, the top diode laser operates by injecting electrons into the QW channel of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24, which lowers the barrier of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 and allows holes to flow over this barrier to the QW of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. In passing over the barrier, very few holes are captured in the QW of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24. Simultaneously, holes diffuse upwards from the QW of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 to the QW of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 where they recombine with the injected electrons to produce stimulated emission. However, it is also noted that the same process of diffusion of holes from the lower p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 to the upper n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 also applies to the electrons injected into the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24. In this way, the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 supplies electrons by diffusion to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. That means there will also be electrons and holes in the lower p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 and therefore recombination and stimulated emission. This means that the lower p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 is not a loss mechanism but instead can contribute to the laser output even though there is no electrical contact to the lower QW structure. The laser contribution of the lower p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 may be somewhat less than the upper n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24. It is also noted that in order for this process to work, the lower p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 must be allowed to float in potential so to allow the carrier diffusion mechanisms to operate as described above. - For the top diode detector, the anode terminal electrode is reversed biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode. The lower p-type region of the active device structure (which includes the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode. The reverse bias conditions are selected such that the device produces photocurrent proportional to the intensity of an optical signal absorbed by the device structure. For the vertical cavity surface detector, the device structure absorbs the optical mode that is received vertically through the top surface of the device structure. For the whispering gallery microresonator, the device structure absorbs the whispering gallery mode that propagates in the waveguide of the whispering gallery microresonator. For the closed-loop microresonator, the device structure absorbs the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator.
- In the vertical cavity surface emitting laser/detector as well as the whispering gallery and closed-loop microresonator, an anode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the p-type modulation doped
QW structure 20, and a cathode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14. One or more optional electrodes can be operably coupled to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 as well as to the top p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 30. If present, these optional electrodes are configured to float electrically with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode. In this manner, the n-type region of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode. Electrically, this configuration operates as an electrically-pumped diode laser or diode detector. This configuration is referred to herein as the bottom diode laser or bottom diode detector because the anode terminal electrode is operably coupled to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20, and a cathode terminal electrode is operably coupled to the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14. - For the bottom diode laser, the anode terminal electrode is forwarded biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode such that holes are injected from the anode terminal electrode into the QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation doped
QW structure 20 in order to induce photon emission within the device structure. The n-type region of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24, when present, floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode. For the vertical cavity surface emitting laser, the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode that is emitted vertically through the top surface of the device structure. For the whispering gallery microresonator, the photon emission within the device structure produces the whispering gallery mode that circulates in the waveguide of the whispering gallery microresonator. For the closed-loop microresonator, the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator. In all these configurations, the bottom diode laser operates by injecting holes into the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. For the case where the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 is present (i.e., it has not been etched away, for example as described with reference to the device ofFIGS. 2A and 2B ), the upper n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 can contribute to emission. It is also noted that in order for this process to work, the upper n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 must be allowed to float in potential so to allow carrier diffusion mechanisms that stimulate such emission to operate. - For the bottom diode detector, the anode terminal electrode is reversed biased relative to the cathode terminal electrode. The n-type region of the modulation doped
QW structure 24 floats with respect to the electrical signals of the anode terminal electrode as well as of the cathode terminal electrode. The reverse bias conditions are selected such that the device produces photocurrent proportional to the intensity of an optical signal absorbed by the device structure. For the vertical cavity surface detector, the device structure absorbs the optical mode that is received vertically through the top surface of the device structure. For the whispering gallery microresonator, the device structure absorbs the whispering gallery mode that circulates in the waveguide region of the whispering gallery microresonator. For the closed-loop microresonator, the device structure absorbs the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator. - In the vertical cavity surface emitting laser/detector as well as the whispering gallery and closed-loop microresonators, at least one anode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the top p-
type contact layer 30, a bottom cathode terminal electrode can be operably coupled to the bottom n-type contact layer 14, an n-channel injector terminal can be operably coupled to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24. A p-channel injector terminal can also be operably coupled to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. Electrically, this configuration operates as an electrically-pumped thyristor laser or thyristor detector. - For the thyristor laser, the device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I s substantially greater than zero) when i) the anode terminal electrode is forward biased with respect to the cathode terminal electrode and ii) the voltage between n-channel injector and the anode electrode is biased such that charge is produced in the n-type modulation doped
QW structure 32 that is greater than the critical switching charge QCR, which is that charge that reduces the forward breakdown voltage such that no off state bias point exists. The voltage between p-channel injector electrode and cathode electrode can also be configured to produce a charge in the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 that is greater than the critical switching charge QCR. The critical switching charge QCR is unique to the geometries and doping levels of the device. The device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the current I through device falls below the hold current of the device for a sufficient period of time such that the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or the charge in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) decreases below the holding charge QH, which is the critical value of the channel charge which will sustain holding action. Thus, if the anode terminal is forward biased with respect to the cathode terminal and the n-channel injector terminal (and/or the p-channel injector terminal) is biased to produce the critical switching charge QCR in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20), then the device will switch to its conducting/ON state. If the current I in the conducting/ON state is above the threshold for lasing ITH, then photon emission will occur within the device structure. For the vertical cavity surface emitting laser, the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode that is emitted vertically through the top surface of the device structure. For the whispering gallery microresonator, the photon emission within the device structure produces the whispering gallery mode signal that circulates in the waveguide region of the whispering gallery microresonator. For the closed-loop microresonator, the photon emission within the device structure produces the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator. - For the thyristor detector, the device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I is substantially greater than zero) in response to an input optical signal that produces charge in the n-type modulation doped
QW structure 24 and/or the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 resulting from photon absorption of the input optical signal. Specifically, the anode terminal electrode is forward biased with respect to the cathode terminal electrode and the voltage between n-channel injector and the anode electrode (and/or the voltage between the p-channel injector and the cathode tei minal electrode) is biased such that that charged produced in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) resulting from photon absorption of the input optical pulse is greater than the critical switching charge QCR. When the input optical signal is removed, the device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) decreases below the holding charge QH. For the vertical cavity surface detector, the device structure absorbs the optical mode that is received vertically through the top surface of the device structure. For the whispering gallery microresonator, the device structure absorbs the whispering gallery mode that circulates in the waveguide region of the whispering gallery microresonator. For the closed-loop microresonator, the device structure absorbs the optical mode signal that circulates in the closed-loop waveguide of the closed-loop microresonator. - In alternate configurations based upon the vertical cavity surface emitting laser/detector as described above, a diffraction grating can be formed in the top mirror over the active device structure described above. For the laser, the diffraction grating performs the function of diffracting light produced within the resonant vertical cavity into light propagating laterally in a waveguide which has the top DBR mirror and
bottom DBR mirror 12 as waveguide cladding layers and which has lateral confinement regions. For the detector, the diffraction grating performs the function of diffracting incident light that is propagating in the lateral direction into a vertical cavity mode, where it is absorbed resonantly in the vertical resonant cavity. - Details of examples of these device structures and specifics of exemplary layer structures utilizing group III-V materials are described in U.S. application Ser. No. 13/921,311, filed on Jun. 19, 2013, and Intern. Pat. Appl. No. PCT/US2012/051265, filed on Aug. 17, 2012, which are commonly assigned to assignee of the present application and herein incorporated by reference in their entireties.
-
FIGS. 2A-2B illustrate an embodiment of awhispering gallery microresonator 200 realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . Thewhispering gallery microresonator 200 is a bottom diode laser or optical detector as describe above. Thus, it can be configured as a laser or as an optical detector. In this embodiment, thewhispering gallery microresonator 200 includes amesa 212 that is formed by etching the layer structure ofFIG. 1 to a depth near the top oflayer 22, and then patterning and etching the resultant structure to define the innerannular sidewall 213 that forms the circular profile of themesa 212 as evident fromFIG. 2A . Theinner sidewall 213 extends to anintermediate mesa 214 formed in the layer structure in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20. Theintermediate mesa 214 has an annular profile as defined by theannular sidewall 213 and an annular sidewall 215 (which is offset radially inside the sidewall 213) as shown inFIG. 2B . - Two
ion implant regions intermediate mesa 214. Theion implant regions ion implant regions FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (i.e., p-type acceptor ions for theion implant region 216 and oxygen species for the ion implant region 218) as described above. Theimplant region 216 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of theannular sidewall 213 as evident fromFIG. 2B . Theimplant region 216 provides for electrical contact to the annular p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 that surrounds theimplant region 216. The ion implant region 218 (which has the deepest depth of the two implant regions) is implanted into the N+-type layer(s) 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of theannular sidewall 213 as evident fromFIG. 2B . In this manner, theimplant region 216 overlies theimplant region 218. The high resistance deep oxygenion implant region 218 effectively blocks current flow therethrough and thus operates to funnel or steer current into the active region of the resonant cavity of the device. Furthermore, the current blocking oxygenion implant region 218 defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 216 and the bottom N+-typeohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure. Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between theanode terminal electrode 222 and thecathode terminal electrode 224 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. - The resultant structure is patterned and etched to form the
annular sidewall 215 that extends downward to acentral bottom mesa 220 formed in the bottomohmic contact layer 14. Thebottom mesa 220 has a circular profile as defined by theannular sidewall 215 as best shown inFIG. 2A . This etching step can also remove the central portion of theimplant regions annular sidewall 215 and the projection ofsidewall 213 as shown inFIG. 2B . - An
anode terminal electrode 222 is formed on theintermediate mesa 214 with an annular pattern that is offset laterally inside theannular sidewall 213 as best shown inFIGS. 2A and 2B . Theanode terminal electrode 222 contacts the p-typeion implant regions 216, which contact the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 of the device structure. Acathode terminal electrode 224 is formed on thebottom mesa 220 in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 as best shown inFIG. 2B . Thecathode terminal electrode 224 can be patterned as a circular tab as best shown inFIG. 2A or can have some other shape. Similar to the source, drain and gate terminal electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect toFIGS. 7A and 7B , the metal of theanode terminal electrode 222 is preferably an Au—Be alloy, and the metal of thecathode terminal electrode 224 is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy. The resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the source, drain and gate electrodes as desired. In one embodiment, the resultant structure can be heated at 420° C. to treat the metal alloys of the anode and cathode electrodes of the device. Such metallization can be carried out in tandem with the metallization of the source, drain and gate electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect toFIGS. 7A and 7B or the electrode of other devices integrally formed on thesubstrate 10. - Following the metallization, the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form sidewalls 226 that extend from the
top mesa 212 to the mirror layers 12. One of the sidewalls 226-1 forms the outer annular periphery of thetop mesa 212. Two other sidewalls 226-2 and 226-3 form a waveguide rib that defines acoupling waveguide 230 extending tangential to the outer annular sidewall 226-1 of the resonator device as best shown onFIG. 2A . The sidewall 226-2 of thecoupling waveguide 230 is offset from the annular sidewall 226-1 by anarrow gap 232 and the height of thecoupling waveguide 230 can match the height of themesa 212 as best shown inFIG. 2B . - A trench etch can expose the bottom mirror layers 12 in the vicinity of both the
whispering gallery microresonator 200 and thecoupling waveguide 230. The exposed bottom minor layers 12 can be oxidized in steam ambient. A dielectric top mirror (not shown) can cover thetop mesa 212 and the annular sidewalls of themicroresonator 200 and thecoupling waveguide 230. The dielectric material of the top minor can fill thegap 232. - The index changes provided by the top mesa 212 (together with the top mirror when present), the inner
annular sidewall 213, the outer annular sidewall 226-1, theion implant regions bottom DBR mirror 12 form a resonant cavity with an disk-shaped annular volume that is configured to support a whispering gallery optical mode signal. The thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can be configured to correspond to at or near one wavelength (for example, a thickness at or near 1 μm for a whispering gallery optical mode signal in the near-infrared range of the electromagnetic spectrum). The thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can encompass relatively equal portions of the layer structure ofFIG. 1 above and below the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20. Thecoupling waveguide 230 provides for evanescent coupling of light to and/or from the resonant cavity of the whisperinggallery microresonator device 200. Electrically, the whisperinggallery microresonator device 200 can operate as an electrically-pumped bottom diode laser or bottom diode detector. - For the bottom diode laser, the
anode terminal electrode 222 is forward biased relative to thecathode terminal electrode 224 such that holes are injected from theanode terminal electrode 222 into the QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 in order to induce photon emission within the device structure. The current-blockingion implant region 218 funnels the injected hole current that flow from theanode terminal electrode 222 and the p-typecontact implant region 216 into the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 within the annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device. Such current funneling enhances the current density of the injected current in the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 within the annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device, which can improve the output power of the device and/or lower the laser threshold voltage of the device. - For the diode detector, the
anode terminal electrode 222 is reversed biased relative to thecathode terminal electrode 224. An input optical light is supplied to thecoupling waveguide 230, which couples the input optical light as a whispering gallery mode signal that propagates in the annular resonant cavity of the whisperinggallery microresonator device 200 for absorption by the device structure. The reverse bias conditions of theanode terminal electrode 222 and thecathode terminal electrode 224 are configured such the diode detector produces photocurrent between theanode terminal electrode 222 and thecathode terminal electrode 224 that is proportional to the intensity of the whispering gallery optical mode absorbed by the device structure. The photocurrent flows between theanode terminal 222 andcathode terminal 224 under the reverse bias. The current-blockingion implant region 218 substantially reduces dark leakage current, which can greatly reduce the sensitivity of the device if not addressed. -
FIGS. 3A-3B illustrate an embodiment of a closed-loop (ring) microresonator 300 realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . Thering microresonator 300 is a bottom diode laser or optical detector as described above. Thus, it can be configured as a laser or as an optical detector. In this embodiment, thering microresonator 300 includes atop mesa 311, anintermediate mesa 312 that is surrounded by thetop mesa 311, and acentral bottom mesa 313 that is surrounded by theintermediate mesa 312. Thetop mesa 311 is formed by the top surface oflayer 30 of the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . Theintermediate mesa 312 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20 to define theannular sidewall 314 that forms the outer circular profile of themesa 312 as evident fromFIG. 3A . Thesidewall 314 extends to theintermediate mesa 313 formed in the layer structure in the spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20. Theintermediate mesa 312 has an annular profile as defined by theannular sidewall 314 and an annular sidewall 315 (which is offset radially inside the sidewall 314) as shown inFIG. 3B . - Two
ion implant regions intermediate mesa 312. Theion implant regions ion implant regions FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (i.e., p-type acceptor ions for theion implant region 316 and oxygen species for the ion implant region 318) as described above. Theimplant region 316 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of theannular sidewall 314 as evident fromFIG. 3B . Theimplant region 316 provides for electrical contact to the annular p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 that surrounds theimplant region 316. The ion implant region 318 (which has the deepest depth of the two implant regions) is implanted into the N+-type layer 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of theannular sidewall 314 as evident fromFIG. 3B . In this manner, theimplant region 316 overlies theimplant region 318. The high resistance deep oxygenion implant region 318 effectively blocks current flow therethrough and thus operates to funnel or steer current into the active region of the resonant cavity of the device. Furthermore, the current blocking oxygenion implant region 318 defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 316 and the bottom N+-typeohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure. Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between theanode terminal electrode 322 and thecathode terminal electrode 324 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. - The resultant structure is patterned and etched to form the
annular sidewall 315 that extends downward to thebottom mesa 313 formed in the bottomohmic contact layer 14. Thebottom mesa 313 has a circular profile as defined by theannular sidewall 313 as best shown inFIG. 3A . This etching step can also remove the central portion of theimplant regions annular sidewall 315 and the projection ofsidewall 314 as shown inFIG. 3B . - An
anode terminal electrode 322 is formed on theintermediate mesa 312 with an annular pattern that is offset laterally inside theannular sidewall 314 as best shown inFIGS. 3A and 3B . Theanode terminal electrode 322 contacts the p-typeion implant regions 316, which contact the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 of the device structure. Acathode terminal electrode 324 is formed on thebottom mesa 313 in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 as best shown inFIG. 3B . Thecathode terminal electrode 224 can be patterned as a circular tab as best shown inFIG. 3A or can have some other shape. Similar to the source, drain and gate terminal electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect toFIGS. 7A and 7B , the metal of theanode terminal electrode 322 is preferably an Au—Be alloy, and the metal of thecathode terminal electrode 324 is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy. The resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the source, drain and gate electrodes as desired. In one embodiment, the resultant structure can be heated at 420° C. to treat the metal alloys of the anode and cathode electrodes of the device. Such metallization can be carried out in tandem with the metallization of the source, drain and gate electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect toFIGS. 7A and 7B or the electrode of other devices integrally formed on thesubstrate 10. - Following the metallization, the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form sidewalls 326 that extend from the
top mesa 311 to the mirror layers 12. One of the sidewalls 326-1 forms the outer annular periphery of thetop mesa 311. Two other sidewalls 326-2 and 326-3 form a waveguide rib that defines acoupling waveguide 330 extending tangential to the outer annular sidewall 326-1 of theresonator device 300 as best shown onFIG. 3A . The sidewall 326-2 of thecoupling waveguide 330 is offset from the annular sidewall 326-1 by anarrow gap 332 and the height of thecoupling waveguide 330 can match the height of the mesa 31 as best shown inFIG. 3B . - A trench etch can expose the bottom mirror layers 12 in the vicinity of both the
ring microresonator 300 and thecoupling waveguide 330. The exposed bottom mirror layers 12 can be oxidized in steam ambient. A dielectric top mirror (not shown) can cover thetop mesa 311 and the annular sidewalls of theresonator 300 and thecoupling waveguide 330. The dielectric material of the top mirror can fill thegap 332. - The index changes provided by the top mesa 311 (together with the top mirror when present), the inner
annular sidewall 314, the outer annular sidewall 326-1, theion implant regions bottom DBR mirror 12 form a resonant cavity with a ring-shaped annular volume that is configured to support circulating propagation of an optical mode signal about the ring-shaped volume. The length of the optical path of the ring-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity is tuned to the particular wavelength of the optical mode signal that is to propagate in the resonant cavity. Specifically, the length L of the optical path is selected to conform to the following: -
-
- where m is an integer greater than zero;
- λe is the wavelength of the optical mode signal that propagates in ring-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity; and
- neff is the effective refractive index of the ring-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity.
The width of the ring-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity (i.e., the radial offset between theannular sidewalls 314, 326-1) can be less than 2 μm, and possibly 1 μm or less. The thickness of the ring-shaped annular volume can be configured to correspond to at or near one wavelength (for example, a thickness at or near 1 μm for an optical mode signal in the near-infrared range of the electromagnetic spectrum). The thickness of the ring-shaped annular volume can encompass relatively equal portions of the layer structure ofFIG. 1 above and below the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20. Thecoupling waveguide 330 provides for evanescent coupling of light to and/or from the resonant cavity of thering microresonator device 300. Electrically, thering microresonator device 300 can operate as an electrically-pumped bottom diode laser or bottom diode detector.
- where m is an integer greater than zero;
- For the bottom diode laser, the
anode terminal electrode 322 is forwarded biased relative to thecathode terminal electrode 324 such that holes are injected from theanode terminal electrode 322 into the QW channel(s) realized in the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 in order to induce photon emission within the device structure. The current-blockingion implant region 318 funnels or steers the injected hole current that flows from theanode terminal electrode 322 and the p-typecontact implant region 316 into the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 within the ring-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device. Such current funneling or steering enhances the current density of the injected current in the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 within the ring-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device, which can improve the output power of the device and/or lower the laser threshold voltage of the device. - For the diode detector, the
anode terminal electrode 322 is reversed biased relative to thecathode terminal electrode 324. An input optical light is supplied to thecoupling waveguide 330, which couples the input optical light as an optical mode signal that circulates in the ring-shaped annular resonant cavity of thering microresonator device 300 for absorption by the device structure. Under reverse bias conditions theanode terminal electrode 322 and thecathode terminal electrode 324 are configured such the diode detector produces photocurrent between theanode terminal electrode 322 and thecathode terminal electrode 324 that is proportional to the intensity of the optical mode signal absorbed by the device structure. The photocurrent flows between theanode terminal 322 andcathode terminal 324 under the reverse bias. The current-blockingion implant region 318 substantially reduces dark leakage current, which can greatly reduce the sensitivity of the device if not addressed. -
FIGS. 4A-4B illustrate an embodiment of a whisperinggallery thyristor microresonator 400 realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . The whisperinggallery thyristor microresonator 400 is a thyristor laser or optical detector as describe above. Thus, it can be configured as a laser or as an optical detector. In this embodiment, the whisperinggallery thyristor microresonator 400 includes atop mesa 411, a firstintermediate mesa 412 that is disposed outside the outer periphery of thetop mesa 411, a secondintermediate mesa 413 that is disposed outside the outer periphery of the firstintermediate mesa 412, athird inteimediate mesa 414 that is disposed inside the inner periphery of thetop mesa 411, and acentral bottom mesa 415 that is disposed inside the inner periphery of the thirdintermediate mesa 414. - The
top mesa 411 is formed by the top surface oflayer 30 of the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . Ananode terminal electrode 423 is formed on thetop mesa 411 with an annular pattern as best shown inFIGS. 4A and 4B . Theanode terminal electrode 423 contacts the top p-typeohmic contact layer 30. The metal of theanode terminal electrode 423 can be tungsten or other suitable metal or alloy. The metal of theanode terminal electrode 423 can be patterned by a lift off by oxide process as described below with respect toFIGS. 9A-9D . - The first
intermediate mesa 412 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in layer(s) 26 above (but near) the n-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 24 to define theannular sidewall 416 that forms the inner circular profile of themesa 412 as evident fromFIG. 4A . Thesidewall 416 extends to the firstintermediate mesa 412 formed in the layer structure in the layer(s) 26 above (but near) the n-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 24. The firstintermediate mesa 412 has an annular profile as defined by theannular sidewall 416 and an annular sidewall 417 (which is offset radially outside the sidewall 416) as shown inFIG. 4B . The patterned metal of theanode terminal electrode 423 can be used as a mask layer for the etch of thesidewall 416 if desired - The second
intermediate mesa 413 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth near the middle of spacer layer(s) 22 to define theannular sidewall 417 that forms the inner circular profile of the secondintermediate mesa 413 as evident fromFIG. 4A . Thesidewall 417 extends to the secondintermediate mesa 413 formed in the layer structure near the middle of the spacer layer(s). - The third
intermediate mesa 414 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20 to define theannular sidewall 418 that forms the outer circular profile of the thirdintermediate mesa 414 as evident fromFIG. 4A . Thesidewall 418 extends to the thirdintermediate mesa 414 formed in the layer structure in the spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20. The thirdintermediate mesa 414 has an annular profile as defined by theannular sidewall 418 and an annular sidewall 419 (which is offset radially inside the sidewall 418) as shown inFIG. 4B . The patterned metal of theanode terminal electrode 423 can be used as a mask layer for the etch of thesidewall 418 if desired. - An
ion implant region 420 is defined by ion implantation of n-type ions through the firstintermediate mesa 412. Theion implant 420 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally outside the projection of theannular sidewall 416 as evident fromFIG. 4B . Theimplant region 420 provides for electrical contact to the annular n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 that surrounds theimplant region 420. - Two
ion implant regions intermediate mesa 414. Theion implant regions ion implant regions FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (i.e., p-type acceptor ions for theion implant region 421 and oxygen species for the ion implant region 422) as described above. Theimplant region 421 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of theannular sidewall 418 as evident fromFIG. 4B . Theimplant region 421 provides for electrical contact to the annular p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 that surrounds theimplant region 421. The ion implant region 422 (which has the deepest depth of the two implant regions) is implanted into the N+-type layer 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally inside the projection of theannular sidewall 418 as evident fromFIG. 4B . In this manner, theimplant region 421 overlies theimplant region 422. The high resistance deep oxygenion implant region 422 effectively blocks current flow therethrough and thus operates to funnel or steer current into the active region of the resonant cavity of the device. Furthermore, the current blocking oxygenion implant region 422 defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 421 and the bottom N+-typeohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure. Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the p-channelinjector terminal electrode 425 and thecathode terminal electrode 426 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. - The resultant structure is patterned and etched to form the
annular sidewall 419 that extends downward to thecentral bottom mesa 415 formed in the bottomohmic contact layer 14. Thebottom mesa 415 has a circular profile as defined by theannular sidewall 419 as best shown inFIG. 4A . This etching step can also remove the central portion of theimplant regions annular sidewall 419 and the projection ofsidewall 418 as shown inFIG. 4B . - An n-channel
injector terminal electrode 424 is formed on the firstintermediate mesa 412 as best shown inFIGS. 4A and 4B . The n-channelinjector terminal electrode 424 contacts the n-typeion implant region 420, which contacts the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 of the device structure. A p-channelinjector terminal electrode 425 is formed on the thirdintermediate mesa 414 with an annular pattern as best shown inFIGS. 4A and 4B . The p-channelinjector terminal electrode 425 contacts the p-typeion implant region 422, which contacts the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 of the device structure. Acathode terminal electrode 426 is formed on thebottom mesa 415 in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 as best shown inFIG. 4B . Thecathode terminal electrode 426 can be patterned as a circular tab as best shown inFIG. 4A or can have some other shape. Similar to the source, drain, gate and collector terminal electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect toFIGS. 7A and 7B , the metal of the p-channelinjector terminal electrode 425 is preferably an Au—Be alloy, and the metal of the n-channel injector terminal 424 and thecathode terminal electrode 426 is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy. The resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the electrodes of the device as desired. In one embodiment, the resultant structure can be heated at 420° C. to treat the metal alloys of the device. Such metallization can be carried out in tandem with the metallization of the source, drain and gate electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect toFIGS. 7A and 7B or the electrode(s) of other devices integrally formed on thesubstrate 10. - Following the metallization, the resultant structure is patterned and etched to form sidewalls 427 that extend from the second
intermediate mesa 413 to the mirror layers 12. One of the sidewalls 427-1 folins the outer annular periphery of the resonator device such that the secondintermediate mesa 413 of theresonator device 400 has an annular profile as defined by theannular sidewall 417 and the annular sidewall 427-1 (which is offset radially outside the sidewall 417) as shown inFIG. 4B . Two other sidewalls 427-2 and 427-3 form a waveguide rib that defines acoupling waveguide 430 extending tangential to the outer annular sidewall 427-1 of theresonator device 400 as best shown onFIG. 4A . The sidewall 427-2 of thecoupling waveguide 430 is offset from the annular sidewall 427-1 by anarrow gap 432 and the height of the coupling waveguide 440 can match the height of themesa 413 of theresonator device 400 as best shown inFIG. 4B . - A trench etch can expose the bottom mirror layers 12 in the vicinity of both the thyristor
whispering gallery microresonator 400 and thecoupling waveguide 430. The exposed bottom mirror layers 12 can be oxidized in steam ambient. A dielectric top mirror (not shown) can cover themesas resonator 400 and thecoupling waveguide 430. The dielectric material of the top mirror can fill thegap 432. - The index changes provided by the mesa 413 (together with the top mirror when present), the inner
annular sidewall 418, the outer annular sidewall 427-1, theion implant regions bottom DBR mirror 12 form a resonant cavity with a disk-shaped annular volume that is configured to support a whispering gallery optical mode signal. The thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can be configured to correspond to at or near one wavelength (for example, a thickness at or near 1 μm for a whispering gallery optical mode signal in the near-infrared range of the electromagnetic spectrum). The thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can encompass relatively equal portions of the layer structure ofFIG. 1 above and below the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20. Thecoupling waveguide 430 provides for evanescent coupling of light to and/or from the resonant cavity of the thyristor whisperinggallery microresonator device 400. Electrically, the thyristor whisperinggallery microresonator device 400 can operate as an electrically-pumped thyristor laser or thyristor detector. - For the thyristor laser, the device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I is substantially greater than zero) when i) the
anode terminal electrode 423 is forward biased with respect to thecathode terminal electrode 426 and ii) the voltage between n-channel injector 424 and theanode electrode 423 is biased such that charge is produced in the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 that is greater than the critical switching charge QCR, which is that charge that reduces the forward breakdown voltage such that no off state bias point exists. The voltage between p-channel injector electrode 425 and thecathode electrode 426 can also be configured to produce a charge in the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 that is greater than the critical switching charge QCR. The critical switching charge QCR is unique to the geometries and doping levels of the device. The device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the current I through device falls below the hold current of the device for a sufficient period of time such that the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or the charge in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) decreases below the holding charge QH, which is the critical value of the channel charge which will sustain holding action. Thus, if theanode terminal 423 is forward biased with respect to thecathode terminal 426 and the n-channel injector terminal 424 (and/or the p-channel injector terminal 425) is biased to produce the critical switching charge QCR in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20), then the device will switch to its conducting/ON state. If the current I in the conducting/ON state is above the threshold for lasing ITH, then photon emission will occur within the device structure. For themicroresonator 400, such photon emission produces the whispering gallery mode signal that circulates in the resonant cavity of themicroresonator 400, which is coupled to thecoupling waveguide 430 to produce an output optical signal that propagates in thecoupling waveguide 430 for output therefrom. The current-blockingion implant region 421 funnels the current that flows from between theanode terminal electrode 423 and thecathode terminal electrode 426 into the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 within the disk-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device. Such current funneling enhances the current density of the injected current in the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 within the disk-shaped annular volume of the resonant cavity of the device, which can improve the output power of the device and/or lower the laser threshold voltage of the device. - For the thyristor detector, an input optical signal is supplied to the
coupling waveguide 430, which couples the input optical signal as a whispering gallery mode optical signal that circulates in the resonant cavity of themicroresonator device 400 for absorption by the device structure. The device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I is substantially greater than zero) in response to the whispering gallery mode optical signal producing charge in the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 and/or the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 resulting from photon absorption of the whispering gallery mode optical signal. Specifically, theanode terminal electrode 423 is forward biased with respect to thecathode terminal electrode 426 and the voltage between n-channel injector 424 and the anode electrode 423 (and/or the voltage between the p-channel injector 425 and the cathode terminal electrode 626) is biased such that that charged produced in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) resulting from photon absorption of the whispering gallery mode optical signal is greater than the critical switching charge QCR. When the whispering gallery mode optical signal is removed, the device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) decreases below the holding charge QH. - For both the thyristor laser and the thyristor detector, the current-blocking
ion implant region 421 reduces the capacitance between the p-channelinjector terminal electrode 425 and thecathode terminal electrode 426 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. -
FIGS. 5A-5E illustrate a configuration of a closed-loop microresonator 500 that can be made utilizing the layer structure ofFIG. 1 , which includes aresonator 501 spaced from a section of a zig-zag waveguide structure 509 by agap region 513. The zig-zag waveguide structure 509 is optically coupled to theresonator 501 by evanescent-wave coupling over thegap region 513. Theresonator 501 defines a resonant cavity, which is referred to herein asactive waveguide 502, that follows a closed path that is generally rectangular in shape. The optical path length of theactive waveguide 502 is tuned to the particular wavelength of theoptical mode signal 504 that is to propagate in thewaveguide 502. Specifically, the length of the rectangular closed path of theactive waveguide 502 is given as 2(L1+L2) and the L1 and L2 parameters are selected to conform to the following: -
-
- where L1 and L2 are the effective lengths of the opposed sides of the
active waveguide 502;- m is an integer greater than zero;
- λD is the wavelength of the
optical mode 504 that is to propagate in theactive waveguide 502; and - neff is the effective refractive index of the
active waveguide 502.
The width (W) of theactive waveguide 502 can be less than 2 μm, and possibly 1 μm or less. The width of the gap region 513 (i.e., the spacing between theactive waveguide 502 and the zig-zag waveguide 509) can be less than 2 μm, and possibly on the order of 1 μm or less.
- where L1 and L2 are the effective lengths of the opposed sides of the
- The
optical mode 504 circulates around theactive waveguide 502 and is strongly confined within theactive waveguide 502 by internal reflection at the reflective interfaces of theactive waveguide 502. The zig-zag waveguide 509 defines a passive rib waveguide that forms a zig-zag path. The optical mode is strongly confined within the zig-zag waveguide 509 by internal reflection at the reflective interfaces of the zig-zag waveguide 509. Theactive waveguide 502 can be logically partitioned in four sections that are coupled to one another by ninety-degree corners as shown inFIG. 5A . The four sections include astraight section 503A that extends parallel to and is closely-spaced from astraight section 511 of the zig-zag waveguide 509 by thegap region 513, astraight section 503B disposed opposite thestraight section 503A, and twostraight sections sections sections Section 503A is configured to provide evanescent coupling to (or from) thestraight section 511 of the zig-zag waveguide 509 for theoptical mode signal 504 that circulates in theactive waveguide 502.Sections optical mode signal 504 that circulates in theactive waveguide 502.Section 503D has a number of portions that perform different functions. Specifically,section 503D has twoopposed end portions sections optical mode signal 504 that circulates in theactive waveguide 502.Segment 503D also has acentral portion 507 that is electrically isolated from the twoopposed end portions passive waveguide portions central portion 507 is configured to provide tuning of the wavelength of theoptical mode signal 504 that circulates in theactive waveguide 502. -
FIG. 5B is a cross-sectional schematic view ofsection 503C of theactive waveguide 502. All of the features of the cross-section extend laterally along the length ofsection 503C as evident fromFIG. 5A . In this description, “inner” refers to features that are closer to the center of thewaveguide 502, and “outer” refers to features that are further away from the center of thewaveguide 502. These features include atop mesa 515 defined between aninner sidewall 517A and anouter sidewall 517B.Ion implant regions top layers waveguide 502 adjacent therespective sidewalls ion implant regions optical mode signal 504 that propagates within the central region of thewaveguide 502. Theinner sidewall 517A extends downward to aninner mesa 519A (which extends laterally to aninner sidewall 521A), while theouter sidewall 517B extends downward to anouter mesa 519B (which extends laterally to anouter sidewall 521A). Both theinner mesa 519A and theouter mesa 519B are formed in the layer structure in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20. Twoimplant regions inner mesa 519A. Theion implant regions ion implant regions FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (p-type acceptor ions for theimplant region 523A and oxygen ions for theimplant region 525A) as described above. Theimplant region 523A (which has the shallowest depth of the twoimplant regions inner sidewall 521A and the projection of theinner sidewall 517A as shown inFIG. 5B . Theimplant region 523A provides for electrical contact to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. Theimplant region 525A (which is deeper in depth than theimplant region 523A) is implanted into the N+-type layer 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally between theinner sidewall 521A and the projection of theinner sidewall 517A as shown inFIG. 5B . In this manner, theimplant region 523A overlies theimplant region 525A. The high resistance deep oxygenion implant region 525A effectively blocks current flow therethrough and defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 523A and the bottom N+-typeohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure. Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the anodeterminal electrode part 533A and the cathodeterminal electrode part 531A of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. - Similarly, two
implant regions outer mesa 519B. Theion implant regions ion implant regions FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (p-type acceptor ions for theimplant region 523B and oxygen ions for theimplant region 525B) as described above. Theimplant region 523A (which has the shallowest depth of the twoimplant regions outer sidewall 521B and the projection of theouter sidewall 517B as shown inFIG. 5B . Theimplant region 523B provides for electrical contact to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. Theimplant region 525B (which is deeper in depth than theimplant region 523B) is implanted into the N+-type layer 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally between theouter sidewall 521B and the projection of theouter sidewall 517B as shown inFIG. 5B . In this manner, theimplant region 523B overlies theimplant region 525B. The high resistance deep oxygenion implant region 525B effectively blocks current flow therethrough and defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 523A and the bottom N+-typeohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure. Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the anodeterminal electrode part 533B and the cathodeterminal electrode part 531B of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. - The
inner sidewall 521A extends downward to aninner bottom mesa 527A formed in the bottomohmic contact layer 14. Theinner bottom mesa 527A extends laterally from theinner sidewall 521A to aninner sidewall 529A as shown inFIG. 5B . Theouter sidewall 521B extends downward to anouter bottom mesa 527B formed in the bottomohmic contact layer 14. Theouter bottom mesa 527B extends laterally from theinner sidewall 521B to theinner sidewall 529B as shown inFIG. 5B . - Two parts (531A, 531B) of a cathode terminal electrode are formed on the inner and outer
bottom mesas FIG. 5B . Two parts (533A, 533B of an anode terminal electrode are formed on the inner andouter mesas respective implant regions QW structure 24 ofsection 503C floats with respect to the electrical signals supplied to anodeterminal electrode parts terminal electrode parts top mirror 535 can cover thetop mesa 515 and thesidewalls - The top mesa 515 (or the
top mirror 535 when present), thesidewalls bottom DBR mirror 12 form part of the closed-path resonant cavity waveguide that is configured to support circulation of theoptical mode signal 504 within the resonant cavity waveguide. The width of the resonant cavity waveguide (i.e., the lateral offset between the sidewalls 517A, 517B) can be less than 2 μm, and possibly 1 μm or less. The height of the vertical cavity waveguide can be above sixty percent of the waveguide width. -
FIG. 5C is a cross-sectional schematic view of the tuningportion 507 ofsection 503D of theactive waveguide 502. All of the features of the cross-section extend laterally along the length of the tuningportion 507 as evident fromFIG. 5A . These features include thetop mesa 515 defined between theinner sidewall 517A and theouter sidewall 517B.Ion implant regions top layers waveguide 502 adjacent therespective sidewalls ion implant regions optical mode signal 504 that propagates within the central region of thewaveguide 502. Thetop mesa 515, thesidewalls waveguide implant regions resonator 500. Theinner sidewall 517A extends downward to an inner mesa 559A (which extends laterally to an inner sidewall 561A), while theouter sidewall 517B extends downward to anouter mesa 559B (which extends laterally to anouter sidewall 561B). Both the inner mesa 559A and theouter mesa 559B are fowled in the layer structure in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20.Implant regions implant regions outer mesa 559B. Theimplant regions section 503C ofFIG. 5B . The inner sidewall 561A extends downward to an inner bottom mesa 567A formed in the bottomohmic contact layer 14. The inner bottom mesa 567A extends laterally from the inner sidewall 561A to aninner sidewall 569A as shown inFIG. 5C . Theouter sidewall 561B extends downward to anouter bottom mesa 567B formed in the bottomohmic contact layer 14. Theouter bottom mesa 567B extends laterally from theouter sidewall 561B to theouter sidewall 569B as shown inFIG. 5C . - Two parts (571A, 571B) of a first tuning terminal electrode are formed on the inner and
outer mesas 559A, 559B, respectively, in contact with theirrespective implant regions QW structure 20 of the tuningportion 507. Two parts (573A, 573B) of a second tuning terminal electrode are formed on the inner and outerbottom mesas 567A, 567B, respectively, in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 of the tuningportion 507 as best shown inFIG. 5C . The high resistance deep oxygenion implant regions type implant regions 523A/523B and the bottom N+-typeohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure. Such isolation regions are each substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduce the capacitance between the firsttuning electrode parts 571A, 571B and the cathodeteitninal electrode parts QW structure 24 of the tuningportion 507 floats with respect to the electrical signals supplied to tuningelectrode parts top mirror 535 can cover thetop mesa 515 and thesidewalls -
FIG. 5D is a cross-sectional schematic view of the isolatingpassive waveguide portion 509B ofsection 503D of theactive waveguide 502. All of the features of the cross-section extend laterally along the length of thepassive waveguide portion 509B as evident fromFIG. 5A . These features include thetop mesa 515 defined between theinner sidewall 517A and theouter sidewall 517B.Ion implant regions top layers waveguide 502 adjacent therespective sidewalls ion implant regions optical mode signal 504 that propagates within the central region of thewaveguide 502. Thetop mesa 515, thesidewalls ion implant regions resonator 500. The inner andouter sidewalls 517A extends downward to bottom mirror layers 12. Atop mirror 535 can cover thetop mesa 515 and thesidewalls passive waveguide portion 509B is formed adjacent one end of the tuningportion 507, while anotherpassive waveguide portion 509A is formed adjacent the opposed end of tuningportion 507 ofsegment 503D. Thepassive waveguide portion 509A has the same features aspassive waveguide portion 509B ofFIG. 5D . The opposedpassive waveguide portions portion 507 from the twoopposed end portions -
FIG. 5E is a cross-sectional schematic view of thecoupling section 503A of theactive waveguide 502 and thestraight section 511 of thezigzag waveguide 509 with thegap region 513 therebetween. All of the features of the cross-section extend laterally along the length of the tuningportion 507 as evident fromFIG. 5A . These features include thetop mesa 515 defined betweeninner sidewall 517A and anouter sidewall 517B.Ion implant regions top layers waveguide 502 adjacent therespective sidewalls ion implant regions optical mode signal 504 that propagates within the central region of thewaveguide 502. Thetop mesa 515, thesidewalls ion implant regions resonator 500. Theinner sidewall 517A extends downward to aninner mesa 519A (which extends laterally to aninner sidewall 521A), while theouter sidewall 517B extends downward to the mirror layers 12. Theinner mesa 519A is formed in the layer structure in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20.Implant regions inner mesa 519A. Theimplant regions section 503C ofFIG. 5B . Theinner sidewall 521A extends downward to aninner bottom mesa 527A formed in the bottomohmic contact layer 14. Theinner bottom mesa 527A extends laterally from theinner sidewall 521A and aninner sidewall 569A as shown inFIG. 5E . - A first control electrode 581 is formed on the
inner mesas 519A in contact with theimplant region 523A, which is in contact with the QW of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 of theactive waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503. Asecond control electrode 583 is formed on theinner bottom mesa 527A in contact with the bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 14 of theactive waveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 as best shown inFIG. 5E . The high resistance deep oxygenion implant region 525A effectively blocks current flow therethrough and defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 523A and the bottom N+-typeohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure. Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the first control electrode 581 and thesecond control electrode 583 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. Note that the n-type region of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 floats with respect to the electrical signals supplied to first control terminal electrode 581. - The
straight section 511 of the zig-zag waveguide 509 is formed from the layer structure ofFIG. 1 by patterning and etching the layer structure to form opposed sidewalls 581-1 and 585-2 that extend from thetop surface 501 to the mirror layers 12. The sidewall 585-1 of thestraight section 511 is offset from thesidewall 517B of thecoupling section 503A by thegap region 513 as shown. A top mirror (not shown) can cover thetop mesa 515 and the sidewalls of the devices. - The etching that forms the sidewalls and mesas of the sections of the
resonator 501 and thecoupling waveguide 509, the ion implantation operations and associated RTA operations for the sections of the sections of theresonator 501 and thecoupling waveguide 509, as well as the metallization of the terminal electrodes of theresonator 501 can be carried in tandem with the formation of like structures in other devices integrally formed on thesubstrate 10. - Electrically, certain portions of the resonator 501 (i.e.,
sections - For the bottom diode laser, the anode terminal electrode (
parts parts parts QW structure 20 in order to induce photon emission within thewaveguide 502 of the device structure. The current-blocking deep oxygen ion implant regionsion implant regions terminal electrode parts contact implant regions QW structure 20 within thewaveguide 502 of the device structure. Such current funneling enhances the current density of the injected current in the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 within thewaveguide 502 of the device structure, which can improve the output power of the device and/or lower the laser threshold current and voltage of the device. The deep oxygenion implant regions parts parts - For the diode detector, the anode terminal electrode (
parts coupling waveguide 509, which couples the input optical light as anoptical mode signal 504 that propagates in thewaveguide 502 of theresonator 501 for absorption by the device structure. The reverse bias conditions of the anode terminal electrode (parts parts parts parts optical mode signal 504 absorbed by the device structure. The photocurrent flows between the anode terminal electrode (parts parts ion implant regions - Electrical signals can be supplied to the first control electrode 581 and the
second control electrode 583 of the coupling section 503 in order to change the coupling coefficient of the evanescent coupling between thewaveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 and thestraight section 511 of thecoupling waveguide 509. Specifically, the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between the two waveguides can be changed (i.e., modulated) by controlling the amount of charge (holes) that fills the QW(s) of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 for thewaveguide 502 of the coupling section 503, which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 for thewaveguide 502 of the coupling section 503. Charge can be added to (or removed from) the QW(s) of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 by a suitable bias current source and/or bias current sink that is electrically coupled to the first control electrode 581. The second control electrode 883 tied to ground potential. For continuous output or input, a DC electrical signal can be supplied to the first control electrode 581 and thesecond control electrode 583 in order to activate and deactivate the evanescent coupling between thewaveguide 502 and thestraight section 511 of thecoupling waveguide 509. Alternatively, a time-varying differential electrical signal can be supplied to the first control electrode 581 and thesecond control electrode 583 in order to modulate the evanescent coupling between thewaveguide 502 and thestraight section 511 of thecoupling waveguide 509. Such coupling modulation generates a modulated optical signal based upon theoptical mode signal 504 that propagates in thewaveguide 502 of theresonator 501. The modulated optical signal propagates through thestraight section 511 of thecoupling waveguide 509 and is output therefrom. The modulated optical signal can have an optical OOK modulation format (i.e., digital pulsed-mode optical signal) or possibly a higher order optical modulation format (such as optical differential phase shift keying format or optical differential quadrature phase shift keying format). - Electrical signals can be supplied to the first tuning electrode (
parts 571A, 571B) and the second tuning electrode (parts portion 507 ofsection 503D in order to tune the characteristic wavelength λD of theoptical mode signal 504 that propagates in thewaveguide 502. Specifically, the bias signal between the first tuning electrode (parts 571A, 571B) and the second tuning electrode (parts QW structure 20 with holes, which shifts the absorption edge to shorter wavelengths and thus induces a significant index change. The index change can modify the length of the optical path of thewaveguide 502 and therefore change the characteristic wavelength λD of theoptical mode signal 504 that propagates in thewaveguide 502. - In alternate embodiments, the active portions of the resonator 501 (i.e.,
sections top layer 30 for an anode terminal electrode (or parts thereof) and electrical contact to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 for a cathode terminal electrode or parts thereof. In this configuration, the active portions of the resonator 501 (i.e.,sections coupling section 503C of theresonator 501 can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact totop layer 30 for a first control terminal electrode and electrical contact to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 for a second control electrode that are used to control the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between thewaveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 and thestraight section 511 of thecoupling waveguide 509. Specifically, the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between two waveguides can be changed (i.e., modulated) by controlling the amount of charge (electrons) that fills the QW(s) of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 for thewaveguide 502 of the coupling section 503, which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 for thewaveguide 502 of the coupling section 503. Similarly, thetuning section 507 of theresonator 501 can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact totop layer 30 for a first tuning electrode and electrical contact to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 for a second tuning electrode that are used to tune the characteristic wavelength λD of theoptical mode signal 504 that propagates in thewaveguide 502. Specifically, the characteristic wavelength λD of theoptical mode signal 504 can be changed (i.e., modulated) by controlling the amount of charge (electrons) that fills the QW(s) of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 for thewaveguide 502 of thetuning section 507, which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 for thetuning section 507 of thewaveguide 502 and the optical path length of thewaveguide 502 of the resonator. - In yet other embodiments, the active portions of the resonator 501 (i.e.,
sections top layer 30 for an anode terminal electrode (or parts thereof) as well as electrical contact to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 for an n-channel injector terminal electrode or parts thereof as well as electrical contact to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 for a p-channel injector terminal electrode or parts thereof as well as electrical contact to the bottom n-type contact layer 14 for a cathode terminal electrode or parts thereof. In this configuration, the active portions of the resonator 501 (i.e.,sections coupling section 503C of theresonator 501 can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact totop layer 30, to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24, to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20, and to the bottom n-type contact layer 14 for control terminal electrodes that are used to control the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between thewaveguide 502 of the coupling section 503 and thestraight section 511 of thecoupling waveguide 509. Specifically, the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between two waveguides can be changed (i.e., modulated) by controlling the amount of charge that fills the QW(s) of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 and/or QW(s) of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 for thewaveguide 502 of the coupling section 503, which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the n-type or p-type modulation doped QW structures for thewaveguide 502 of the coupling section 503. Similarly, thetuning section 507 of theresonator 501 can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact totop layer 30, to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24, to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20, and to the bottom n-type contact layer 14 for tuning electrodes that are used to tune the characteristic wavelength λD of theoptical mode signal 504 that propagates in thewaveguide 502. Specifically, the characteristic wavelength λD of theoptical mode signal 504 that propagates in thewaveguide 502 can be changed (i.e., modulated) by controlling the amount of charge that fills the QW(s) of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 and/or QW(s) of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 for thewaveguide 502 of thetuning section 507, which dictates the shifting of the absorption edge and index of refraction of the QW(s) of the n-type or p-type modulation doped QW structures for thewaveguide 502 of thetuning section 507 and the optical path length of thewaveguide 502 of the resonator. - In alternate embodiments, the
tuning section 507 can be realized as part of any one of the other optical resonator structures as described herein in order to provide tunability of the wavelength of the optical mode processed by the optical resonator structure. -
FIGS. 5F-5H illustrate a configuration of a closed-loop (rectangular path) microresonator 500′ that includes aresonator 501′ and electrically-controlledtuning reflector 591 that are realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . Theresonator 501′ is spaced from a section of a zig-zag waveguide structure 509′ by a gap region. The zig-zag waveguide structure 509′ is optically coupled to theresonator 501′ by evanescent-wave coupling over the gap region. Similar to theresonator 501 of the embodiment ofFIGS. 5A-5E as described above, theresonator 501′ defines anactive waveguide 502′ that follows a closed path that is generally rectangular in shape. The optical path length of theactive waveguide 502′ is tuned to the particular wavelength of the optical mode signal that is to propagate in thewaveguide 502′. However, the tuning section and isolating passive waveguide sections of thewaveguide 502 of the embodiment ofFIGS. 5A-5E is omitted and replaced with an active section similar to thesection 503C ofFIG. 5B . Moreover, wavelength tuning functionality is carried out by the tuningreflector 591 that is formed as part of thecoupling waveguide 509. - In this embodiment, the
active waveguide 502′ of theresonator 501′ is configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact totop layer 30 for an anode terminal electrode (or parts thereof) and electrical contact to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 for a cathode terminal electrode or parts thereof. A collector terminal can be in electrical contact to the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 if desired. In this configuration, theactive waveguide 502′ of theresonator 501′ can operate as a top diode laser or top diode detector as described herein. Similarly, the coupling section of theresonator 501′ can be configured with mesas, contact implants and metallization for electrical contact totop layer 30 for a first control terminal electrode and electrical contact to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 for a second control electrode that are used to control the coupling coefficient of the evanescent-wave coupling between thewaveguide 502′ of the coupling section and the straight section of thecoupling waveguide 509′ as described herein. - In principle, the
resonator 501′ produces light that propagates in both the clockwise and counterclockwise sense along the optical path of thewaveguide 502′ of theresonator 501′ as indicted by the two sets of arrows inFIG. 5F . Moreover, the evanescent coupling between the coupling section of theresonator 501′ and the straight section of thecoupling waveguide 509′ operates on both clockwise and counterclockwise light propagation within theresonator 501′. Specifically, the light propagating clockwise within theresonator 501′ is coupled to thecoupling waveguide 509′ to produce light that propagates in thecoupling waveguide 509′ toward the right side ofFIG. 5F , and light propagating counterclockwise within theresonator 501′ is coupled to thecoupling waveguide 509′ to produce light that propagates in thecoupling waveguide 509′ toward the left side ofFIG. 5F . - Similarly, the evanescent coupling between the straight section of the
coupling waveguide 509′ and the coupling section of theresonator 501′ operates on both directions of light propagation within thecoupling waveguide 509′. Specifically, light propagating in the straight section of the coupling waveguide toward the right side ofFIG. 5F is coupled to theresonator 501′ to produce light that propagates clockwise in theresonator 501′, and light propagating in the straight section of the coupling waveguide toward the left side ofFIG. 5F is coupled to theresonator 501′ to produce light that propagates counterclockwise in theresonator 501′. - The tuning
reflector 591 is a linear active waveguide device formed as a reflector that builds upon the multiple directions of light propagation in theresonator 501′ as well as the multiple directions of evanescent coupling provided between the straight section of thecoupling waveguide 509′ and the coupling section of theresonator 501′. The tuningreflector 591 has Bragg grating (such as a first-order or third-order Bragg grating) defined throughout the length of the active waveguide device. The Bragg grating can be defined by etching into the top layers (such aslayers FIG. 1 ) as shown inFIG. 5G . The Bragg grating operates to reflect any optical modes exiting the straight section ofcoupling waveguide 509 in the direction of thetuning reflector 591 where the wavelength of such optical modes coincides with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating. All optical modes at other wavelengths will be passed through the tuningreflector 591 or be absorbed. - For laser operations, the
resonator 501′ produces optical mode(s) that propagate counter-clockwise within thewaveguide 502′ of theresonator 501′, which are coupled into thecoupling waveguide 509′ to produce optical mode(s) that propagate in thecoupling waveguide 509′ to thetuning reflector 591. The incident optical mode(s) at wavelengths that coincide with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of thetuning reflector 591 are reflected back and propagate in the reverse direction within thecoupling wave guide 509′ where the mode is coupled into theresonator 501′ to produce optical mode(s) that propagates clockwise in theresonator 501′ and generate more stimulated emission. This operation is repeated many times such that the wavelength of dominant optical mode that propagates in theresonator 501 corresponds to the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating. Such dominant optical mode propagating clockwise in theresonator 501 is coupled to thecoupling waveguide 509 to produce an output optical signal (which propagates in the direction away from the tuningreflector 591 and labeled “desired output direction” inFIG. 5F ). In this manner, optical modes that coincide with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of thetuning reflector 591 make double passes through theresonator 501′ for improved stimulated emission. This operation is repeated such that the wavelength of the dominant or primary optical mode that propagates in theresonator 501′ corresponds to the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating. With this operation, the dominant or primary optical mode that propagates in theresonator 501′ is output from thecoupling waveguide 509′, while optical modes that do not coincide with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of thetuning reflector 591 are removed from the output signal by the operation of thetuning reflector 591. - For optical detection operations, the input optical signal is supplied to the
coupling waveguide 509′ from the end opposite thetuning reflector 591. Such input optical signal is coupled into theresonator 501′ to produce optical mode(s) that propagate counter-clockwise within thewaveguide 502′ of theresonator 501′ for absorption. Some counter-clockwise propagating optical modes that are not absorbed can be coupled into thecoupling waveguide 509′ to produce optical mode(s) that propagate in thecoupling waveguide 509′ to thetuning reflector 591. The incident optical mode(s) with wavelengths that coincide with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of thetuning reflector 591 are reflected back and propagate in the reverse direction within thecoupling waveguide 509′ where the mode is coupled into theresonator 501′ to produce optical mode(s) that propagate clockwise in theresonator 501′ for additional absorption. In this manner, optical modes that coincide with the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of thetuning reflector 591 make double passes through theresonator 501′. This operation is repeated such that the wavelength of the dominant or primary optical mode that propagates in theresonator 501′ corresponds to the Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating. - For both laser operations and optical detection operations, the Bragg grating functions as a narrow-band filter where the Bragg frequency of grating that dictates the wavelength of the dominant or primary optical mode that propagates in the
resonator 501′. Such narrow-band filtering is useful for larger closed-loop resonators where the natural mode resonances are closely spaced from one another and thus do not provide a narrow wavelength band for the optical mode that propagates in the closed-loop resonator. - The Bragg frequency of the Bragg grating of the
tuning reflector 591 can be electronically-controlled (or tuned) by controlled injection of charge that modifies the index of the region n2 of the Bragg grating as noted inFIG. 5L . The charge injection can be controlled by traveling wavesurface electrode parts top surface 30 on opposite sides of the Bragg grating along the length of the device as shown inFIG. 5G . Ion implantedsource regions QW structure 24 of the device.Waveguide implants 594A, 594B can be formed on opposite sides of the Bragg grating at or near the same depth of the Bragg grating along the length of the device as shown.Intermediate electrode parts source regions surface electrode parts collector terminal electrode 596 can be formed on anion implant region 597 that contacts the p-type modulation dopedinterface 20 of the device structure. A top mirror can be formed over the device structure as shown inFIG. 5H . The CPW defined by traveling wavesurface electrode parts intermediate electrode parts FIG. 5F . Charge injection that modulates the index n2 can be controlled by applying a traveling wave electrical RF signal to the CPW, and the Bragg grating frequency corresponding to the time dependent index n2 value can be obtained. Because the tuning is achieved by charge injection into the QW(s) of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 of the device, the collector bias can change the voltage at which this happens similar to the threshold voltage of an HFET. Therefore the voltage window for tuning can be adjusted for the range of input signal. Note that for a 1st and 3rd order gratings, the reflected wavelength λo and grating pitch Λ are related by Λ=λo/2n eff and Λ=3λo/2n eff, respectively wheren eff is some function of the index n1 and the index n2 such asn eff=(n1+n2)/2. The electrical traveling wave will have a velocity of c=co/nelec where co is the velocity of light and nelec is effective index for the electrical wave, which is another function of n1 and n2 and the spacing between the traveling wavesurface electrode parts - Moreover, if the electrical velocity on the CPW (i.e., the rate at which the RF signal supplied to the CPW advances on the transmission line and given by c=co/nelec) and the optical velocity (the rate at which the optical signal advances in the optical waveguide of the
tuning reflector 591, which is bounded at the top by the Bragg grating, and given by =co/n eff) match one another (which is achieved whenn eff=nelec), the maximum change of index n2 for a given charge injection level will be obtained. - Advantageously, the closed-
loop microresonator 500′ ofFIGS. 5F-5G can be configured to provide the functionality equivalent to a tunable DFB laser with higher speed, wider tunability, and a wider variety of electronic integration than is currently not possible in state-of-the-art technology. - In alternate embodiments, the tuning
reflector 591 can be realized as part of the coupling waveguide structure in conjunction with any one of the other optical resonator structures as described herein in order to provide tunability of the wavelength of the optical mode processed by the optical resonator structure. -
FIGS. 6A-6C illustrate a split-electrode vertical cavitysurface emitting device 600 realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . Thedevice 600 can logically be partitioned into two parts, aleft half 601 and aright half 602 that each have a generally half-circular top profile as shown inFIG. 6A . Atop mesa 612 extends across both theleft half 601 and the right half 603 as best shown inFIG. 6B . A firstintermediate mesa 618 is defined on theleft side 601 outside the outer periphery of thetop mesa 612. The firstintermediate mesa 618 is formed above (but near) the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24. A secondintermediate mesa 620 is defined on the right side 603 outside the outer periphery oftop mesa 612 and opposite the firstintermediate mesa 618. The secondintermediate mesa 620 is formed above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20. Abottom mesa 622 is defined by the n-type layer 14 outside the periphery of both the firstintermediate mesa 618 and the secondintermediate mesa 620 and extends across both theleft half 601 and the right half 603 as best shown inFIG. 6B . - The
top mesa 612 is formed by the top surface oflayer 30 of the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . An ion implant region 616 (preferably of n-type ions) can be implanted through thetop mesa 612 to a depth within the one or more the top p-type layers 28, 30 on theleft half 601 of the device. Theion implant region 616 can have a half-circle profile that provides a current barrier that funnels current injected from theanode terminal electrode 614 into the active region 650 defined by theright half 602 of the device as illustrated byarrow 651 inFIG. 6B . - The
anode terminal electrode 614 is formed on thetop mesa 612 with a half-circle pattern as best shown inFIG. 6A . Theanode terminal electrode 614 contacts the top p-typeohmic contact layer 30. The metal of theanode terminal electrode 614 can be tungsten or other suitable metal or alloy. The metal of theanode terminal electrode 614 as well as theimplant region 616 can be formed by a lift off by oxide process as described below with respect toFIGS. 9A-9D . - The first
intermediate mesa 618 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in layer(s) 26 above (but near) the n-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 24 to define the sidewall that forms the half-circle profile of themesa 618 for theleft half 601 of the device as evident fromFIG. 6A . The patterned metal of theanode terminal electrode 614 can be used as a mask layer for the etch of this sidewall if desired. - The second
intermediate mesa 620 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20 to define the sidewall that forms the half-circle profile of themesa 620 for theright half 602 of the device as evident fromFIG. 6A . - An
ion implant region 624 is defined by ion implantation of n-type ions through the firstintermediate mesa 618. Theion implant 624 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 with the half-circle pattern that is disposed laterally outside the projection of the sidewall that leads to the first intermediate mesa. Theimplant region 624 provides for electrical contact to the annular n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 of the twohalves - An
ion implant region 626 is defined by ion implantation of p-type ions through the secondintermediate mesa 620. Theimplant region 626 provides for electrical contact to the annular p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 of the twohalves implant regions ion implant region 626 is similar to theion implant region 719 of the p-channel HFET as described above with respect toFIG. 7 and can be implanted together with this implants with the same p-type acceptor ions species and annealed as described above. - High resistance deep oxygen
ion implant regions n+ contact layer 14 through theintermediate mesas right halves ion implant regions gap 630 that is devoid of the current blocking oxygen ions. An RTA is then performed in order to activate the oxygenion implant regions ion implant regions ion implant region 721 of the p-channel HFET as described above with respect toFIG. 7 and can be implanted together and annealed as described above. - The resultant structure is patterned and etched to form the annular sidewalls that extends downward to the
bottom mesa 622 formed in the bottomohmic contact layer 14. Thebottom mesa 622 has a circular profile outside the periphery of the firstintermediate mesa 618 and the secondintermediate mesa 620 for the left andright halves - An n-channel
injector terminal electrode 632 is formed on the firstintermediate mesa 618 of theleft half 601 with a half-circle pattern as best shown inFIGS. 6A and 6B . The n-channelinjector terminal electrode 632 contacts the n-typeion implant region 624, which contacts the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 of the device structure. A p-channelinjector terminal electrode 634 is formed on the secondintermediate mesa 620 of theright half 602 with a half-circle pattern as best shown inFIGS. 6A and 6B . The p-channelinjector terminal electrode 634 contacts the p-typeion implant region 626, which contacts the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 of the device structure. Thegap 630 of the oxygen implant region is positioned adjacent a cathode terminal electrode 636 (which is preferably shaped as a small tab) that is formed on a portion of thebottom mesa 622 adjacent thegap 630 as evident from theFIGS. 6A and 6C . Thegap 630 provides a narrow pathway for current flow from the active region 650 to thecathode terminal electrode 636 as evident fromFIG. 6C . Similar to the source, drain, gate and collector terminal electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect toFIGS. 7A and 7B , the metal of the p-channelinjector terminal electrode 634 is preferably an Au—Be alloy, and the metal of the n-channel injector teiminal 632 and thecathode terminal electrode 636 is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy. The resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the electrodes of the device as desired. Such metallization can be carried out in tandem with the metallization of the source, drain and gate electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect toFIGS. 7A and 7B or the electrode(s) of other devices integrally formed on thesubstrate 10. - Following the metallization, a trench etch can expose the bottom mirror layers 12. The exposed bottom mirror layers 12 can be oxidized in steam ambient. A top mirror (not shown) can cover the
mesas device 600, if desired. The index changes provided by the top mesa 612 (together with the top mirror when present), the sidewalls of theright half 601, the current blockingimplant 616, and thebottom DBR mirror 12 form a resonant cavity of a vertical cavity laser emitter or detector. The top surface of themesa 612 of the right half 602 (which is left open and not covered by the anode metal 614) defines an aperture that leads to the active region 650 of this vertical cavity. Electrically, the verticalcavity thyristor device 500 can operate as an electrically-pumped thyristor laser or thyristor detector. - For the thyristor laser, the device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I is substantially greater than zero) when i) the
anode teuninal electrode 614 is forward biased with respect to thecathode terminal electrode 636 and ii) the voltage between n-channel injector 632 and theanode electrode 614 is biased such that charge is produced in the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 that is greater than the critical switching charge QCR, which is that charge that reduces the forward breakdown voltage such that no off state bias point exists. The voltage between p-channel injector electrode 634 and thecathode electrode 636 can also be configured to produce a charge in the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 that is greater than the critical switching charge QCR. The critical switching charge QCR is unique to the geometries and doping levels of the device. The device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the current I through device falls below the hold current of the device for a sufficient period of time such that the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or the charge in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) decreases below the holding charge QH, which is the critical value of the channel charge which will sustain holding action. Thus, if theanode terminal 614 is forward biased with respect to thecathode terminal 636 and the n-channel injector terminal 632 (and/or the p-channel injector terminal 634) is biased to produce the critical switching charge QCR in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or in the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20), then the device will switch to its conducting/ON state. If the current I in the conducting/ON state is above the threshold for lasing ITH, then photon emission will occur within the device structure. For the verticalcavity thyristor device 600, such photon emission produces an optical signal that exits through the aperture in thetop mesa 612 for output therefrom. The current-blocking oxygenion implant regions anode terminal electrode 614 and thecathode terminal electrode 636 into the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 within the vertical resonant cavity of the device. Such current funneling enhances the current density of the injected current in the QW channel of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 within the vertical resonant cavity of the device, which can improve the output power of the device and/or lower the laser threshold voltage of the device. - For the thyristor detector, an input optical signal is injected through the aperture in the
top mesa 612 into the vertical cavity of the device for absorption by the device structure. The device structure switches from a non-conducting/OFF state (where the current I through the device is substantially zero) to a conducting/ON state (where current I is substantially greater than zero) in response to the optical signal producing charge in the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 and/or the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 resulting from photon absorption of the optical signal. Specifically, theanode terminal electrode 614 is forward biased with respect to thecathode terminal electrode 636 and the voltage between n-channel injector 632 and the anode electrode 614 (and/or the voltage between the p-channel injector 634 and the cathode terminal electrode 636) is biased such that that charged produced in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) resulting from photon absorption of the whispering gallery mode optical signal is greater than the critical switching charge QCR. When the whispering gallery mode optical signal is removed, the device switches from the conducting/ON state (where the current I is substantially greater than zero) to a non-conducting/OFF state (where current I is substantially zero) when the charge in the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (and/or the p-type modulation doped QW structure 20) decreases below the holding charge QH. - For both the thyristor laser and the thyristor detector, the current-blocking
ion implant regions injector terminal electrode 634 and thecathode teitninal electrode 636 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. -
FIGS. 8A to 8C illustrate a dual-wavelength hybrid device 800 realized as part of an optoelectronic integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . The dual-wavelength hybrid device 800 is a hybrid of two parts: a central part that operates as a vertical cavity device at a first wavelength corresponding to the material of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24, and an outside part that operates as a whispering gallery mode device at a second wavelength corresponding to the material of the p-type modulation dopedstructure 20. Thedevice 800 includes atop mesa 812 with an annular shallow trench that forms a firstintermediate mesa 814. Abottom mesa 824 is defined outside the outer periphery of the secondintermediate mesa 822. - The
top mesa 812 is formed by the top surface oflayer 30 of the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . A split anode terminal electrode with two concentricannular parts top mesa 812 as best shown inFIGS. 8A and 8B . The anodeterminal electrode parts ohmic contact layer 30. The metal of the anodeterminal electrode parts - Two
ion implant regions top mesa 812 to a depth within thetop layers ion implant regions terminal electrode parts terminal electrode parts ion implant regions FIGS. 9A-9D . - The shallow trench that defines the first
intermediate mesa 814 is disposed between the two anodeterminal electrode parts quantum well structure 24. The firstintermediate mesa 814 has an annular profile that is concentrically located between the two anodeterminal electrode parts terminal electrode parts - The second
intermediate mesa 822 is formed by patterning and etching the layer structure to a depth in spacer layer(s) 22 above (but near) the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20 as evident fromFIG. 8B . The secondintermediate mesa 822 is defined by an annular sidewall 817-1 that extends down from the outer periphery of thetop mesa 812 as shown inFIGS. 8B and 8C . The secondintermediate mesa 822 has a generally annular profile that extends laterally outside the outer periphery of thetop mesa 812 as evident fromFIGS. 8A and 8B . The patterned metal of the outside anodeterminal electrode part 818B can be used as a mask layer for the etch of the sidewall 817-1 if desired. The outside current blocking implant region 820 can be offset laterally from the sidewall 817-1 as evident fromFIG. 8B . - The patterning and etching of the sidewall 817-1 can also define two opposed sidewalls 817-2 and 817-3 of a waveguide rib that defines a
coupling waveguide 838 extending tangential to the outer annular sidewall 817-1 of thedevice 800 as best shown onFIG. 8A . The sidewall 817-2 of thecoupling waveguide 838 is offset from the annular sidewall 817-1 by anarrow gap 840 and the height of thecoupling waveguide 838 can match the height of thetop mesa 812 of thedevice 400 as best shown inFIG. 8C . - An
ion implant region 825 is defined by ion implantation of n-type ions through the firstintermediate mesa 814. Theion implant 825 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally within the projections of the annular sidewalls of the shallow top trench as evident fromFIG. 8B . Theimplant region 825 provides for electrical contact to the annular n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 that surrounds theimplant region 825 on both sides of theimplant region 825. - Two
ion implant regions intermediate mesa 822. Theion implant regions ion implant regions FIG. 7 and can be implanted together with these implants with the same ions species (p-type acceptor ions for theimplant region 828 and oxygen ions for the implant regions 830) and annealed as described above. Theimplant region 828 is implanted to a depth that encompasses the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 with an annular pattern that is disposed laterally outside the projection of the annular sidewall that extends downward to the secondintermediate mesa 822 as evident fromFIG. 8B . Theimplant region 828 provides for electrical contact to the annular p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 that is surrounded by theimplant region 828. The ion implant region 830 (which has the deepest depth of the two implant regions) is implanted into the N+-type layer 14 with a pattern that is disposed laterally outside the projection of the annular sidewall that extends downward to the secondintermediate mesa 822 as evident fromFIG. 8B . In this manner, theimplant region 828 overlies theimplant region 830. The high resistance deep oxygenion implant region 830 effectively blocks current flow therethrough and thus operates to funnel or steer current into the active region of the resonant cavity of the device. Furthermore, the current blocking oxygen ion implant region 820 defines an isolation region between the p-type implant region 828 and the bottom N+-typeohmic contact layer 14 of the layer structure. Such isolation region is substantially devoid of conducting species and significantly reduces the capacitance between the p-channelinjector terminal electrode 834 and thecathode terminal electrode 836 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. - The resultant structure is patterned and etched to form a generally annular sidewall that extends downward to the
bottom mesa 824 formed in the bottomohmic contact layer 14. Thebottom mesa 824 has a generally circular profile outside the periphery of the secondintermediate mesa 822 as shown inFIG. 8A . - An n-channel
injector tettninal electrode 816 is formed on the firstintermediate mesa 814 with an annular pattern as best shown inFIGS. 8A and 8B . The n-channelinjector terminal electrode 816 contacts the n-typeion implant region 825, which contacts the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 of the device structure. A p-channelinjector terminal electrode 834 is formed on the secondintermediate mesa 822 with a generally annular pattern as best shown inFIGS. 8A and 8B . The p-channelinjector terminal electrode 834 contacts the p-typeion implant region 828, which contacts the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 of the device structure. Thegap 832 in the deep oxygenion implant region 830 is positioned adjacent a cathode terminal electrode 836 (which is preferably shaped as a small tab) that is formed on a portion of thebottom mesa 824 adjacent thegap 832 as evident from theFIGS. 8A and 8C . Thegap 832 provides a narrow pathway for current flow from the central and peripheral active regions to thecathode terminal electrode 836 as evident fromFIG. 8C . Similar to the source, drain, gate and collector terminal electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect toFIGS. 7A and 7B , the metal of the p-channelinjector terminal electrode 834 is preferably an Au—Be alloy, and the metal of the n-channel injector terminal 832 and thecathode terminal electrode 836 is preferably an Au—Ge—Ni alloy. The resultant structure can be heated to treat the metal alloys of the electrodes of the device as desired. Such metallization can be carried out in tandem with the metallization of the source, drain and gate electrodes of the p-channel HFET device as described above with respect toFIGS. 7A and 7B or the electrode(s) of other devices integrally formed on thesubstrate 10. - Following the metallization, a trench etch can expose the bottom mirror layers 12. The exposed bottom mirror layers 12 can be oxidized in steam ambient. A dielectric top mirror (not shown) can cover the
mesas device 800, if desired. The dielectric material of the top mirror can fill thegap 840. - The index changes provided by the top mesa 812 (together with the top mirror when present and the
bottom DBR mirror 12 in the central region of the device and possible other parts of the device foam a resonant cavity of a thyristor vertical cavity laser emitter or detector. The top surface of themesa 812 in the central region of the device (which is left open and not covered by theanode metal portions implants bottom DBR mirror 12 in the periphery of the device form a resonant cavity having an annular volume that supports propagation of a whispering gallery mode. The thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can be configured to correspond to at or near one wavelength (for example, a thickness at or near 1 for a whispering gallery optical mode signal in the near-infrared range of the electromagnetic spectrum). The thickness of the disk-shaped annular volume can encompass relatively equal portions of the layer structure ofFIG. 1 above and below the p-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 20. Thecoupling waveguide 838 provides for evanescent coupling of light to and/or from the peripheral resonant cavity of thedevice 800 that supports propagation of a whispering gallery mode. - The
device 800 can be configured to perform a first optical mode conversion function where an in-plane optical signal (which is input to the coupling waveguide 838) is converted to a vertical optical mode signal that is emitted from the central aperture of thedevice 800. Specifically, a whispering gallery mode is coupled into the peripheral resonant cavity from thecoupling waveguide 838 by evanescent coupling. This whispering gallery mode propagates around the peripheral resonant cavity, where it is absorbed by the device structure. Such absorption adds charge to the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or to the P-type modulation doped structure 20) such that the channel charge exceeds the critical switching charge QCR, which turns the central thyristor vertical cavity device ON. The ON current is configured to produce a vertical cavity mode for output. - In one embodiment, the first optical mode conversion function can be configured to perform wavelength conversion where the in-plane optical signal input to the
coupling waveguide 838 is at a first wavelength λ1 (e.g., 980 nm), and the vertical mode emitted from the central active region of thedevice 800 is at a second wavelength λ2 (e.g., 1310 nm). In this embodiment, the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 can include one or more QD layers that are configured to absorb at the first wavelength λ1, and the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 can include one or more QD layers that are configured to emit at second wavelength λ2. The electrodes of the device are biased such that the thyristor action turns ON in response to detection of the whispering gallery mode at the first wavelength λ1 and turns OFF when the whispering gallery mode at the first wavelength λ1 is not present, and the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 with suitable QD layers emit at the second wavelength λ2 when the thyristor action is ON. - The
device 800 can also be configured to perform a second optical mode conversion function where a vertical optical mode is supplied to thedevice 800 and injected through the central aperture of thedevice 800 and converted to an in-plane optical signal that is output from thecoupling waveguide 838. Specifically, a vertical optical mode is supplied to thedevice 800 and injected through the central aperture of thedevice 800 where it is absorbed by the device structure of the vertical resonant cavity. Such absorption adds charge to the QW(s) of the n-type modulation doped QW structure 24 (or to the P-type modulation doped structure 20) such that the channel charge exceeds the critical switching charge QCR, which turns the central thyristor vertical cavity device ON. The ON current is configured to produce a whispering gallery mode in the peripheral resonant cavity, which is coupled to thecoupling waveguide 838 by evanescent coupling and produces the in-plane optical signal for output. - In one embodiment, the second optical mode conversion function can be configured to perform wavelength conversion where vertical mode injected into the central active region of the
device 800 is at a first wavelength λ1 (e.g., 1310 nm), and the in-plane optical signal output by thecoupling waveguide 838 is at a second wavelength λ2 (e.g., 980 nm). In this embodiment, the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 can include one or more QD layers that are configured to absorb at the first wavelength λ1, and the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 20 can include one or more QD layers that are configured to emit at second wavelength λ2. The electrodes of the device are biased such that the thyristor action turns ON in response to detection of the vertical cavity mode at the first wavelength λ1 and turns OFF when the vertical cavity mode at the first wavelength λ1 is not present, and the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 with suitable QD layers emit at the second wavelength λ2 when the thyristor action is ON. - For both the thyristor laser and the thyristor detector, the current-blocking
ion implant regions injector terminal electrode 834 and the cathode teiuiinal electrode 686 of the device. This capacitance can drastically lower the speed of response of the device if not reduced. -
FIG. 9A to 9D illustrate exemplary fabrication steps that form dopant implant regions that are self-aligned to patterned metal for an aperture that is part of optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit wafer that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . An aperture is formed at the top surface of the layer structure to allow for light to exit or enter into the active region of the device. Anode metal regions and/or implant regions can be used to block light from exiting or entering into the active region of the device structure and thus form the boundary of the aperture. In the steps ofFIGS. 9A to 9D , a first mask is deposited and patterned on thetop surface 901 oflayer 30 of the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . In the one embodiment, the first mask comprises a dual layer structure of oxide and nitride as shown. The mask preferably has a thickness of 4000-5000 A. The pattern of the mask defines afeature 901 that protects the area of theaperture 905 that results from the process as shown inFIG. 9D . - Then, one or more implant regions (such as two
implant regions mask feature 903. In one embodiment, the one or more implant regions (e.g.,regions type layers 26 and 28 of the layer structure ofFIG. 1 . In this case, the implant region 9 s) employ n-type species of sufficient density that convert the p-type implanted region to n-type and produce a pn junction that blocks the flow of hole current flow vertically downwards. This forces the hole current to flow laterally to the un-implanted active region of the device structure disposed below theaperture 905. In another, embodiment, the implant region(s) can be implanted to a depth below the QW(s) of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24. This requires higher energy to place the implant regions below such QW(s). In this case, theimplant regions QW structure 24. The larger barrier means that p-type conduction over this barrier is reduced and so the hole current from the top contact flows laterally where the barrier is lower (i.e., the vertically down conduction is blocked) preferentially to the un-implanted active region of the device structure disposed below theaperture 905. The ions species of the implant region(s) can be Si ions due to its lower mass and larger possible range. SiF ions may also be used. The advantage of locating the current blocking implant region(s) below the QW of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 24 is that the top p-type layers 28 and 30 can be made thinner (preferably a 1/2 λ, above the QW), which makes it easier to fabricate HFETs with a lower profile topology. Another advantage of this approach is a lower laser resistance and therefore reduced heat generation in the laser active region which is important for stable laser operation in the integrated environment. The implant region(s) can also provide for lateral confinement of light within the active region of the device structure disposed below theaperture 905. - Next, the
metal material 909 for the top surface electrode, which can be tungsten or some other suitable metal or metal alloy, is deposited such that it covers thetop surface 901 and themask feature 903 as shown inFIG. 9B . - Next, a second mask 911 (preferably formed from photoresist material) is deposited and patterned to define a window that overlies the
mask feature 903. The window is used as part of an etch operation that etches through the window down through themetal 909 and themask feature 901 to a depth at or near thetop surface 901 in the area that results in theaperture 905. The window is smaller than the width of themask feature 901, and thus leaves behind one or more sidewalls (such as theopposed sidewalls mask feature 901. The sidewall(s) of the mask feature can have a width dimension on the order of 1-2 μm. This etch operation can employ an anisotropic etching process that define a near vertical profile for the sidewall(s) of the mask feature. An example of a suitable anisotropic etching process is dry reactive ion etching employing SF6. - With the
second mask 911 remaining in place or possibly removed, the resultant structure is etched in BOE (Buffered Oxide Etch). The BOE etches sideways and undercuts the sidewall(s) (e.g., sidewalls 915A, 915B) of themask feature 901 as well as the adjacent sidewall(s) of themetal material 909 and the overlying second mask 911 (if present) to form the resultant structure as shown inFIG. 9D . In this resultant structure, theaperture 905 is formed between the opposedsurface electrode parts 909A, 909B. This procedure is designated lift-off by oxide. - Note that the current blocking implant(s) are disposed adjacent the
aperture 905 below the corresponding surface electrode. Specifically, the opposed edge(s) of the implant region(s) are aligned laterally with the opposed edges of the surface electrode that define the boundaries of the aperture. This self-aligned configuration of the implant region(s) and the surface electrode is advantageous because it can eliminate one mask procedure, aid in minimizing resistance of the top surface layers 26, 28, 30 and aid in producing uniformity and higher yield over large areas. - In alternate embodiments, the surface electrode that define the boundaries of the aperture can be patterned and etched away after metallizing all of the electrodes of the devices of the integrated circuit and prior to depositing the dielectric material of the top mirror of such device, if used.
- In yet other embodiments, the n-type and p-type doping characteristics of the epitaxial layer of
FIG. 1 can be reversed with respect to one another. In this configuration, the bottom layers 14′, 16′ have p-type doping. Thebottom layer 14′ provides a P+-type ohmic contact layer. An n-type modulation doped quantum well structure 20′ can be formed above the bottom layers 14′, 16′. The n-type modulation dopedstructure 20′ has a layer of N+-type modulation doping on the bottom side of thestructure 20′. A p-type modulation doped quantum well structure 24′ can be formed above the n-type modulation dopedstructure 20′. The p-type modulation dopedstructure 24′ has a layer of P+-type modulation doping on the top side of thestructure 24′. The top layers 26′, 30′ have n-type doping. Thetop layer 30′ provides an N+-type ohmic contact layer. - In yet other embodiments, any one of the optical resonators as described herein can be replicated to form an array of optical emitters or detectors for parallel optical data links or wavelength division multiplexed operations. Moreover, any one of the optical resonator and coupling waveguide systems as described herein can be replicated and positioned adjacent one another to provide for optical switching functions between input and output waveguides and possibly other optical functions as desired.
- In still other embodiments, the devices as described herein can be formed from the device structure of
FIG. 10 , which includes a bottom distributed Bragg reflector (DBR)mirror layers 1003 formed onsubstrate 1001. The bottomDBR mirror layers 1003 are typically formed by depositing pairs of semiconductor or dielectric materials with different refractive indices. When two materials with different refractive indices are placed together to foul' a junction, light will be reflected at the junction. The amount of light reflected at one such boundary is small. However, if multiple junctions/layer pairs are stacked periodically with each layer having a quarter-wave (λ/4) optical thickness, the reflections from each of the boundaries will be added in phase to produce a large amount of reflected light (e.g., a large reflection coefficient) at the particular center wavelength λC. Deposited upon the bottom DBR mirror layers 1003 is ametamorphic buffer 1005 that significantly reduces strain due lattice mismatch between the overlying active device structure and the underlying bottomDMR mirror layers 1003 andsubstrate 1001. Specifically, themetamorphic buffer 1005 accommodates lattice mismatch between the underlying structure (bottomDBR mirror layers 1003 and substrate 1001) and the overlying structure (the alloys of the active device structure) and absorbs strain due to such lattice mismatch while minimizing the nucleation of dislocations. Deposited on themetamorphic buffer 1005 is one ormore spacer layers 1007 followed by an active device structure suitable for realizing complementary heterostructure field-effect transistor (HFET) devices. The first of these complementary HFET devices is a p-channel HFET which has a p-type modulation doped quantum well (QW)structure 1015 with an n-type gate region (i.e., bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1009 and bottom n-type region layer(s) 1011) below the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 1015. One ormore spacer layers 1013 is disposed between the p-type modulation doped quantum well (QW)structure 1015 and the underlying bottom n-type layer(s) 1011. One or more spacer/barrier layers 1017 are disposed above the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 1015. A QD-In-QW structure 1019 is formed above the spacer/barrier layer(s) 1017, where the QD-In-QW structure 1019 includes at least one QW layer with self-assembled quantum dots (QDs) embedded therein. The second of these complementary HFET devices is an n-channel HFET which includes an n-type modulation dopedQW structure 1027 with a p-type gate region (i.e., p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1033 and p-type layer(s) 1031) formed above the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 1027. One ormore spacer layers 1029 is disposed between the n-type modulation doped quantum well (QW)structure 1027 and the overlying p-type layer(s) 1031. One or more spacer/barrier layers 1025 are formed below the n-type modulation doped quantum well (QW)structure 1027. A QD-In-QW structure 1023 is formed below the spacer/barrier layer(s) 1025, where the QD-In-QW structure 1023 includes at least one QW layer with self-assembled quantum dots (QDs) embedded therein. One or more spacer layer(s) 1021 are formed between the QD-In-QW structure 1019 and the QD-In-QW structure 1023. The layers encompassing the spacer layer(s) 1021 and the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 1027 forms the collector region of the p-channel HFET. Similarly, the layers encompassing thespacer layer 1021 and the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 1015 forms the collector region of the n-channel HFET. Such collector regions are analogous to the substrate region of a MOSFET device as is well known. Therefore a non-inverted n-channel HFET device is stacked upon an inverted p-channel HFET device as part of the active device structure. - The active device layer structure begins with bottom n-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1009 which enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto. Deposited on layer(s) 1009 are one or more n-
type layers 1011 and one or more spacer layer(s) 1013 which serve electrically as part of the gate of the p-channel HFET device and optically as a part of the lower waveguide cladding of the device. Deposited on layer(s) 1013 is the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 1015 that defines a p-type charge sheet offset from one or more QWs (which may be formed from strained or unstrained heterojunction materials) by an undoped spacer layer. The p-type charge sheet is formed first below the undoped spacer and the one or more QWs of the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 1015. All of the layers grown thus far form the p-channel HFET device with the gate ohmic contact on the bottom. Deposited on the p-type modulation dopedQW structure 1015 is one or more spacer/barrier layers 1017. Deposited on the spacer/barrier layer(s) 1017 is the QD-In-QW structure 1019 (which corresponds to the p-type modulation doped QW structure 1015). The spacer layer(s) 1021 is then formed on the QD-In-QW structure 1019. - Deposited on the spacer layer(s) 1021 is the QD-In-QW structure 1023 (which corresponds to the n-type modulation doped QW structure 1027) followed by one or more spacer layers(s) 1025. The n-type modulation doped
QW structure 1027 is formed on the spacer layer(s) 1025. The n-type modulation dopedQW structure 1027 defines an n-type charge sheet offset from one or more QWs by an undoped spacer layer. The n-type charge sheet is formed last above the undoped spacer and the one or more QWs of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 1027. - Deposited on the n-type modulation doped
QW structure 1027 is one or more spacer layer(s) 1029 and one or more p-type layers 1031, which can serve electrically as part of the gate of the n-channel HFET and optically as part of the upper waveguide cladding of the device. Preferably, the p-type layers 1031 include two sheets of planar doping of highly doped p-material separated by a lightly doped layer of p-material. These p-type layers are offset from the n-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 1027 by the spacer layer(s) 1029. In this configuration, the top charge sheet achieves low gate contact resistance and the bottom charge sheet defines the capacitance of the n-channel HFET with respect to the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 1027. Deposited on p-type layer(s) 1031 is one or more p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1033, which enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto. Deposited on the p-type ohmic contact layer(s) 1033 is anoptical guide layer 1035. - The self-assembled quantum dots (QDs) embedded within the QD-in-
QW structures FIG. 10 . Specifically, the population inversion necessary for laser action and amplification and the photon absorption mechanism for necessary for optical detection occurs more efficiently with the introduction of the quantum dots and thus decreases the necessary current required for lasing action and amplification increases the photocurrent produced by absorption. Furthermore, the size of the embedded QDs can be controlled to dictate the wavelength of the desired optical function (emission for lasing, amplification, absorption for detection). For example, the size of the QDs in either or both QD-in-QW structures1019, 1023 can be controlled to dictate the wavelength in range from 1300 nm up to 1550 nm for use in the O to L (1260-1625 nm) bands employed in commercial optical telecommunication networks. Furthermore, the density distribution of the embedded QDs can be controlled to dictate the laser output power. High density of embedded QDs can provide for an increase of laser output power, but require a greater threshold lasing current. - The QD-in-
QW structures - The template substructures each include an un-graded QW with self-assembled QDs embedded therein. The self-assembled QDs can be formed during molecular beam epitaxy growth by a self-assembly method known as the Stranski-Krastanov process. In this process, an initial layer (such as InGaAs) that is part an ungraded quantum well is deposited. A compound semiconductor that is lattice mismatched relative to the initial layer and underlying layer is deposited on the initial layer. In particular, the lattice mismatch of the compound semiconductor is such that the growth forms three dimensional islands after a deposition of a critical thickness of the compound semiconductor. The growth is continued to allow the three dimensional islands to expand to form the self-assembled QDs that have the desired characteristic dimensional range. After the self-assembled QDs are formed on the initial layer, the deposition of the ungraded QW material resumes such that the self-assembled QDs are covered and fully embedded within the ungraded QW material.
- The emission substructures each include an analog-graded QW with self-assembled QDs embedded therein. The self-assembled QDs can be formed during molecular beam epitaxy growth by a self-assembly method known as the Stranski-Krastanov process similar to the growth conditions of the template substructure. In this process, an initial layer (such as InGaAs) that is part an analog-graded quantum well is deposited. A compound semiconductor that is lattice mismatched relative to the initial layer and underlying layer is deposited on the initial layer. In particular, the lattice mismatch of the compound semiconductor is such that the growth forms three dimensional islands after a deposition of a critical thickness of the compound semiconductor. The three dimensional islands of the emission substructure are formed such that they are aligned with the self-assembled QDs of the underlying template structure. The growth is continued to allow the three dimensional islands to expand to form the self-assembled QDs that have the desired characteristic dimensional range. After the self-assembled QDs are formed on the initial layer, the deposition of the analog-graded QW material resumes such that the self-assembled QDs are covered and fully embedded within the analog-graded QW of the respective emission structure.
- The size of the QDs of the template and emission substructures can dictate the wavelength of the electromagnetic radiation emitted or absorbed for the desired optical function (laser emission, amplification, optical detection). For example, the size of the QDs of the template and emission substructures can be controlled to dictate the emission/absorption wavelength in range from 1300 nm up to 1550 nm for use in the O to L (1260-1625 nm) bands employed in commercial optical telecommunication networks. Furthermore, the characteristic emission/absorption wavelengths can be different for QDs of the template and emission substructures for the QD-in-
QW structures QW structure 1019 can be controlled to dictate the emission/absorption wavelength in range near 1310 nm, and the size of the QDs of the template and emission substructures for the QD-in-QW structure 1023 can be controlled to dictate the emission/absorption wavelength in range near 1550 nm. - Furthermore, the density distribution of the QDs of the template and emission substructures dictates the laser output power. A high density of embedded QDs can provide for an increase of laser output power, but require a greater threshold lasing current. The density distribution of the QDs of the template substructures dictates the density distribution of the QDs of the adjacent emission substructure and allows the growth conditions of the emission substructure to be tuned to control the size of the QDs of the adjacent emission substructure. Furthermore, the template substructure relaxes the strain mismatch of the emission substructure that arises from the layer underlying the template substructure and thus allows for the larger sized QDs to be assembled in the adjacent emission substructure.
-
FIGS. 11A-F , collectively, illustrate an exemplary layer structure utilizing group III-V materials for realizing the device structure ofFIG. 10 as described herein. The layer structure ofFIGS. 11A-F can be made, for example, using known molecular beam epitaxy (MBE) techniques. Starting fromFIG. 11F , asemiconductor layer 1103 of aluminum arsenide (AlAs) and asemiconductor layer 1105 of gallium arsenide (GaAs) are alternately deposited (with preferably at least seven pairs) upon a semi-insulating GaAs substrate 1101 in sequence to form the bottom DBR mirror layers. The number of AlAs layers will preferably always be one greater than the number of GaAs layers so that the first and last layers of the mirror are shown aslayer 1103. In the preferred embodiment, the AlAs layers 1103 are subjected to high temperature steam oxidation during fabrication to produce the compound AlxOy so that a mirror will be formed at the designed center wavelength. This center wavelength is selected such that all of the desired resonant wavelengths for the device structures will be subject to high reflectivity. In one embodiment, the thicknesses oflayers layers DBR mirror layers 1003 ofFIG. 10 as described above. The substrate 1101 corresponds to thesubstrate 1001 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Deposited on the last
bottom mirror layer 1103 is the metamorphic buffer that significantly reduces strain due lattice mismatch between the overlying active device structure of InGaAs material as described herein and the underlying bottom DBR mirror layers and the GaAs substrate 1101. Specifically, the metamorphic buffer accommodates lattice mismatch between the underlying structure (bottomDBR mirror layers 1003 and substrate 1001) and the overlying structure (the alloys of the active device structure) and absorbs strain due to such lattice mismatch while minimizing the nucleation of dislocations. The metamorphic buffer begins with abuffer layer 1107 of undoped GaAs having a typical thickness of 34 Å. Asuper-lattice 1109 of Aly1Ga(1-y1)As and GaAs are alternately deposited (with preferably at least five pairs) on thebuffer layer 1107. Aly1Ga1-y1)As is an alloy of AlAs and GaAs where the parameter y1 is the proportion of AlAs and (1-y1) is the proportion of GaAs. The parameter y1 is preferably at or near 50% (more preferably at 52%) for thesuper-lattice 1109. The Aly1Ga(1-y1)As layers and the GaAs layers of the super-lattice 1109 have a typical thickness of 2.4 Åand 1.4 Å, respectively. Next, alayer 1111 of Inx1Al(1-x1)As is deposited on thesuper-lattice 1109. Inx1Al(1-x1)As is an alloy of InAs and AlAs where the parameter x1 is the proportion of InAs and (1-x1) is the proportion of AlAs. The parameter x1 is preferably graded in an analog manner from 5% to 28% forlayer 1111. The Inx1Al(1-x1)Aslayer 1111 has a typical thickness of 340 Å. The grading is carried out in the growth direction for all graded layers ofFIGS. 11A-11F . The substrate temperature is controlled to a temperate preferably at or near 600° C. when depositing layers 1102 to 1109. Next, aninverse step layer 1113 of Inx1Al(1-x1)As is deposited onlayer 1111. The parameter x1 is preferably graded in an analog manner from 28% to 25% forlayer 1113 and thus layer 1113matches layers 1111 at the interface betweenlayers layer 1113 has a typical thickness of 20 Å. The substrate temperature is controlled to a temperate preferably in the range of 400-450° C. when depositinglayers 1111 to 1235 as described herein. Next, ahealing layer 1115 of Inx1Al(1-x1)As is deposited onlayer 1113. The parameter x1 is constant preferably at 25% forlayer 1115 and thus layer 1115matches layer 1113 at the interface betweenlayers layer 1115 has a typical thickness of 120 Å. Next, alayer 1117 of Inx1Al(1-x1)As is deposited onlayer 1115. The parameter x1 is preferably graded in an analog manner from 25% to 52% forlayer 1117 and thus layer 1117matches layer 1115 at the interface betweenlayers layer 1117 has a typical thickness of 380 Å. Next, aninverse step layer 1119 of Inx1Al(1-x1)As is deposited onlayer 1117. The parameter x1 is preferably graded in an analog manner from 52% to 49% forlayer 1119 and thus layer 1119matches layer 1117 at the interface betweenlayers layer 1119 has a typical thickness of 20 Å. Next, ahealing layer 1121 of Inx1Al(1-x1)As is deposited onlayer 1119. The parameter x1 is constant preferably at 49% forlayer 1121 and thus layer 1121matches layer 1119 at the interface betweenlayers layer 1121 has a typical thickness of 110 Å. Note that the inverse step and healing layers of the metamorphic buffer provide a relatively abrupt change of strain in the respective inverse step layers and thus promotes isolated threading dislocations in the inverse step layers while reducing threading dislocations in the layers thereabove and thus provide smoother growing surfaces. Thelayers 1107 to 1121 corresponds to themetamorphic buffer 1005 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Deposited on
layer 1121 is aspacer layer 1123 of undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)As. Inx1Ga(1-x1)As is an alloy of InAs and GaAs where the parameter x1 is the proportion of InAs and (1-x1) is the proportion of GaAs. The parameter x1 is constant preferably at 53% forlayer 1123. The Inx1Ga(1-x1)Aslayer 1123 has a typical thickness of 200 Å. The Inx1Ga(1-x1)Aslayer 1123 functions to eliminate anti-null absorption. Thespacer layer 1123 corresponds to thespacer layer 1007 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Deposited on
spacer layer 1123 is the active device structure which begins withlayer 1125 of N+ type Inx1Ga(1-x1)As that enables the formation of ohmic contacts thereto. The parameter x1 is constant preferably at 53% forlayer 1125 and thus layer 1125matches spacer layer 1123.Layer 1125 has a typical thickness near 3000 Å and a typical n-type doping of 3.5×1018cm−3. The N+ doped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Aslayer 1125 corresponds to the bottom n-typeohmic contact layer 1009 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Deposited on
layer 1125 islayer 1127 of n-type Inx1Al(1-x1)As with a typical thickness of 600-1000 Å and a typical doping of 5×1017cm−3. The parameter x1 is preferably 52% forlayer 1127. The wideband material oflayer 1125 serves as part of the gate region of the p-channel HFET device and optically as a small part of the lower waveguide cladding of the respective optical device. Note that a majority of the lower waveguide cladding for waves propagating in the guide formed by the optically active region of the device is provided by the lower DBR mirror itself. Next are four layers (1129, 1131, 1133, 1135) comprising a stack of an alternating tertiary alloy of InGaAs and a quaternary alloy of InAlGaAs. These four layers collectively have a total thickness of about 125 Å and doped N+ with a typical n-type doping of 3.5×1018cm−3. Thefirst layer 1129 is a tertiary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As where the parameter x1 is preferably 53% and with a typical thickness of 12 Å. Thesecond layer 1131 is a quaternary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As. Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As is an alloy of InAs, AlAs and GaAs where the parameter x1 is the proportion of InAs, the parameter x2 is the proportion of AlAs and (1-x1-x2) is the proportion of GaAs. The parameters x1 and x2 forlayer 1131 is preferably 53% and 21%, respectively, andlayer 1131 has a typical thickness of 20 Å. Thethird layer 1133 is a tertiary alloy of Inx1Ga(1-x1)As where the parameter x1 oflayer 1133 is preferably 53% and with a typical thickness of 12 Å. Thefourth layer 1135 is a quaternary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As where the parameters x1, x2 oflayer 1135 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively, andlayer 1135 has a typical thickness of 80 Å. The stack oflayers layer 1131. The n-type layers 1127 to 1135 correspond to the bottom n-type layer(s) 1011 ofFIG. 10 . - Next is an
undoped layer 1137 formed from a quaternary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As, where the parameters x1 and x2 oflayer 1137 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.Layer 1137 has a typical thickness of 300 Å. Theundoped InAlGaAs layer 1137 corresponds to the spacer layer(s) 1013 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Next is a thin p-
type charge sheet 1139 formed from a quaternary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As, where the parameters x1 and x2 oflayer 1139 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.Layer 1139 is doped P+ with a typical p-type doping of 7×1018cm−3 and has a typical thickness of 40 Å. Next is aundoped spacer layer 1141 formed from the quaternary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As, where the parameters x1 and x2 oflayer 1141 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.Layer 1141 has a typical thickness of 30 Å. Next, an undopedInGaAs barrier layer 1143 and an InGaAsquantum well layer 1145 are repeated for a number of quantum wells (such as three or more quantum wells) for the inverted p-type modulation doped quantum structure. Single quantum well structures may also be used. The undopedInGaAs barrier layer 1143 is formed from a tertiary alloy of Inx1Ga(1-x1)As, where the parameter x1 is preferably 53%.Layer 1143 has a typical thickness of 15 Å. The InGaAsquantum well layer 1145 is formed from a tertiary alloy of Inx1Ga(1-x1)As, where the parameter x1 is preferably 70%.Layer 1145 has a typical thickness of 60 Å.Layers 1139 to 1145 correspond to the inverted p-type modulation dopedquantum structure 1015 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - An
undoped InGaAs layer 1147 follows the last InGaAs quantum well layer. Theundoped InGaAs layer 1147 is formed from a tertiary alloy of Inx1Ga(1-x1)As, where the parameter x1 is preferably 53%.Layer 1147 has a typical thickness of 300-500 Å.Layer 1147 corresponds tospacer layer 1017 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Following
layer 1147 arelayers 1149 to 1177 that correspond to the QD-inQW structure 1019 ofFIG. 10 as described above.Layers 1149 to 1153 form the template QD structure with InAs QDs embedded within a non-graded Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well where the parameter x1 is 70%. Theinitial layer 1149 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1151) is preferably about 2 Å thick. Thelayer 1153 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40-60 Å thick. An undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1155 is deposited on the InGaAsquantum well layer 1153. The parameter x1 of the undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1155 is preferably 53%.Layer 1155 has a typical thickness of 100 Å.Layers 1157 to 1161 form the emission QD structure on thebarrier layer 1155. The emission QD structure includes InAs QDs embedded within an Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that employs analog grading of In content. Theinitial layer 1157 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1159) is preferably about 40 Å thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface tobarrier layer 1155 to the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence. Thelayer 1161 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1159) is preferably about 40 Å thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence to the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface tobarrier layer 1163. - An undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)As
barrier layer 1163 is deposited on the top InGaAsquantum well layer 1161. The parameter x1 of the undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1163 is preferably 53%. The undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1163 is preferably about 300-500 Å thick. - Following
barrier layer 1163 arelayers 1165 to 1169 that form the template QD structure with InAs QDs embedded within a non-graded Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well where the parameter x1 is 70%. Theinitial layer 1165 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1167) is preferably about 2 Å thick. Thelayer 1169 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40-60 Å thick. An undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1171 is deposited on the InGaAsquantum well layer 1169. The parameter x1 of the undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1171 is preferably 53%.Layer 1171 has a typical thickness of 100 Å.Layers 1173 to 1177 form the emission QD structure on thebarrier layer 1171. The emission QD structure includes InAs QDs embedded within an Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that employs analog grading of In content. Theinitial layer 1173 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1175) is preferably about 40 Å thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface tobarrier layer 1175 to the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence. Thelayer 1177 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1175) is preferably about 40 Å thick and has analog grading of In content from the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence to the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface tospacer layer 1179. - Next is an
undoped spacer layer 1179 formed from a quaternary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As, where the parameters x1 and x2 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.Layer 1179 has a typical thickness of 4000 Å.Layer 1179 correspond to the spacer layer(s) 1021 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Following the
spacer layer 1179 arelayers 1181 to 1211 that correspond to the QD-inQW structure 1023 ofFIG. 10 as described above.Layer 1181 is an undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)As barrier layer preferably with the parameter x1 of 53% and with a thickness on the order of 300-500 Å.Layers 1183 to 1187 fatal the template QD structure with InAs QDs embedded within a non-graded Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well where the parameter x1 is 70%. Theinitial layer 1183 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1185) is preferably about 2 Å thick. Thelayer 1187 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40-60 Å thick. An undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1189 is deposited on the InGaAsquantum well layer 1153. The parameter x1 of the undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)AsInGaAs barrier layer 1189 is preferably 53%.Layer 1189 has a typical thickness of 100 Å.Layers 1191 to 1195 form the emission QD structure on thebarrier layer 1189. The emission QD structure includes InAs QDs embedded within an Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that employs analog grading of In content. Theinitial layer 1191 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1193) is preferably about 40 Å thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface tobarrier layer 1189 to the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence. Thelayer 1195 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1193) is preferably about 40 Å thick and has analog grading of In content from the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence to the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface tobarrier layer 1197. - An undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)As
barrier layer 1197 is deposited on the top InGaAsquantum well layer 1195. The parameter x1 of the undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1197 is preferably 53%. The undopedInGaAs barrier layer 1197 is preferably about 300-500 Å thick. - Following
barrier layer 1197 arelayers 1199 to 1203 that form the template QD structure with InAs QDs embedded within a non-graded Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well with the parameter x1 of 70%. Theinitial layer 1199 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1201) is preferably about 2 Å thick. Thelayer 1203 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence is preferably about 40-60 Å thick. An undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1205 is deposited on the InGaAsquantum well layer 1203. The parameter x1 of the undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1205 is preferably 53%.Layer 1205 has a typical thickness of 100 Å.Layers 1207 to 1211 form the emission QD structure on thebarrier layer 1205. The emission QD structure includes InAs QDs embedded within an Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that employs analog grading of In. content Theinitial layer 1207 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited before the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1209) is preferably about 40 Å thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface tobarrier layer 1205 to the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence. Thelayer 1211 of the Inx1Ga(1-x1)As quantum well that is deposited after the InAs QD growth sequence (specified as 1209) is preferably about 40 Å thick and has analog grading of In content with the parameter x1 of 70% at the interface of the InAs QD growth sequence to the parameter x1 of 53% at the interface tobarrier layer 1213. - An undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)As
barrier layer 1213 is deposited on the InGaAsquantum well layer 1211. The parameter x1 of the undoped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Asbarrier layer 1213 is preferably 53%.Layer 1213 has a typical thickness of 300-500 Å and corresponds to thespacer layer 1025 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Next is an InGaAs
quantum well layer 1215 and an undopedInGaAs barrier layer 1217 that are repeated for a number of quantum wells (such as three or more quantum wells) for the n-type modulation doped quantum structure. Single quantum well structures may also be used. The InGaAsquantum well layer 1215 is formed from a tertiary alloy of Inx1Ga(1-x1)As, where the parameter x1 is preferably 706%.Layer 1215 has a typical thickness of 60 Å. The undopedInGaAs barrier layer 1217 is formed from a tertiary alloy of Inx1Ga(1-x1)As, where the parameter x1 is preferably 53%.Layer 1217 has a typical thickness of 15 Å. Next is aundoped spacer layer 1219 formed from a quaternary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As where the parameters x1 and x2 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.Layer 1219 has a typical thickness of 30 Å. Next is a thin n-type charge sheet 1221 formed from a quaternary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As, where the parameters x1 and x2 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively.Layer 1221 is doped N+ with a typical n-type doping of 3.5×1018cm−3 and has a typical thickness of 80 Å. Thelayers 1215 to 1221 corresponds to the n-type modulation dopedquantum well structure 1027 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Next is an
undoped layer 1223 formed from a quaternary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As, where the parameters x1 and x2 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively. Layer 11223 has a typical thickness of 300 Å. The undopedInAl GaAs layer 1223 corresponds to the spacer layer(s) 1029 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Next are three layers (1225, 1227, 1229) that have a total thickness of about 700-800 Å and are doped with p-type doping. The
first layer 1225 is a quaternary alloy of Inx1Alx2Ga(1-x1-x2)As where the parameters x1 and x2 are preferably 53% and 21%, respectively. Thefirst layer 1225 is P+ doped with a typical p-type doping of 7×1018cm−3 and has a typical thickness of 60 Å. Thesecond layer 1227 is a tertiary alloy of Inx1Ga(1-x1)As where the parameter x1 is preferably 53%. Thesecond layer 1227 is P+ doped with a typical p-type doping of 7×1018cm−3 and has a typical thickness of 12 Å. Thethird layer 1229 is a tertiary alloy of Inx1Al(1-x1)As where the parameter x1 is preferably 52%. Thethird layer 1229 is P doped with a typical p-type doping of 5×1017cm−3 and has a typical thickness of 700 Å. The wideband material oflayer 1229 serves as part of the gate region of the n-channel HFET device and optically as upper waveguide cladding of the respective optical device. The n-type layers 1225 to 1229 correspond to the top n-type layer(s) 1031 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Next is
layers layers Layer 1231 has a typical thickness near 900 Å and a typical p-type doping of 7×1018cm−3.Layer 1233 has a typical thickness near 60 Å and a typical p-type doping of 1×1020cm−3. The P+ doped Inx1Ga(1-x1)Aslayers FIG. 10 as described above. - Deposited on
layer 1233 islayer 1235 of undoped inx1Ga(1-x1)As with a typical thickness of 700-1000 Å (more preferably near 870 Å). The parameter x1 forlayer 1233 is preferably 53%.Layer 1235 can be used to form an aperture for optical devices (such as VCSELs) as described herein and to form active and passive in-plane optical waveguide structures (such as the active and passive sections of the closed-path waveguides) as described herein.Layer 1233 corresponds to theoptical guide layer 1035 ofFIG. 10 as described above. - Note that the size of the embedded QDs of the template and emission substructures of the template and emission QD substructures contributes to the emission/absorption wavelength of such structures. In one embodiment, the embedded QDs of the template and emission substructures have the following characteristics:
- QDs of the emission substructure having a maximal characteristic dimension of 50-60 Å for production/absorption of light with a characteristic wavelength at or near 1310 nm, and QDs of the template substructure having a maximal characteristic dimension of 20-30 Å (which are of smaller size that the emission substructure) for production/absorption of light with a characteristic wavelength at or near 1310 nm;
- QDs of the emission substructure having maximal characteristic dimension of 20-30 Å for production/absorption of light with a characteristic wavelength at or near 1430 nm, and QDs of the template substructure having a maximal characteristic dimension of 20-30 Å (which are of smaller size that the emission substructure) for production/absorption of light with a characteristic wavelength at or near 1430 nm;
- QDs of the emission substructure having a maximal characteristic dimension of 100-110 Å for production/absorption of light with a characteristic wavelength at or near 1550 nm, and QDs of the template substructure having a maximal characteristic dimension of 20-30 Å (which are of smaller size that the emission substructure) for production/absorption of light with a characteristic wavelength at or near 515 nm; and
- QDs with an aspect ratio on the order of three (i.e., the characteristic base dimension of the QD is about three times larger than the characteristic height dimension of the QD).
Such QD size and aspect ratio are dictated by growth conditions, particularly the number of monolayers for three dimensional InAs QD growth. For example, 2 ML of three dimensional InAs QD growth can be used for the template substructures, and 3.2 ML of three dimensional InAs QD growth can be used for the emission substructures. Other suitable monolayer growths can be used as well. Moreover, the thickness of the barrier layer(s) between the QDs of the template substructure and the emission substructure can be controlled in order that the strain energy from the template substructure have a desired influence on the larger dot size and quality of the emission substructure. Moreover, the In concentration of the analog graded quantum well material onto which the QDs are grown can be used to control the amount of strain and thus the maximum size of the QDs formed thereon. For example, the analog graded quantum well layers of the emission substructures can have a maximum relative concentration of In greater than 70% (for example up to or beyond 90%) in order to reduce the amount of strain and thus increase the maximum size of the QDs formed thereon. - Also note the incorporation of In into the quantum wells of the n-type and p-type modulation doped quantum well structures can greatly improve the frequency response (i.e., higher cutoff frequencies) for transistor devices including the n-channel HFET and the p-channel HFET devices.
-
FIGS. 12A to 12I illustrate exemplary fabrication steps that form an optical feature (such as an aperture) this is aligned to patterned metal and one mnore underlying implant regions as part of optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 10 . The optical feature is formed at the top surface of the layer structure ofFIG. 10 . The optical feature can be an aperture that allows for light to exit or enter into the active region of the device. The patterned metal regions and one or more underlying implant regions can be used to block light from exiting or entering into the active region of the device structure and thus form the boundary of the aperture. Similar methodology can also be used to form a passive and/or active in-plane waveguide structures as part of optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit that employs the layer structure ofFIG. 10 . Such in-plane waveguide guides the propagation of light in the plane of the integrated circuit, and the optical feature formed at the top surface provides for vertical confinement and wave guiding of light for the top portion of the integrated circuit wafer. For the passive in-plane waveguide structure, the patterned metal can be omitted. - In the steps of
FIGS. 12A to 12I , a protective layer 1201 (preferably formed from silicon nitride) is deposited on the top surface oflayer 1035 ofFIG. 10 as shown inFIGS. 12A and 12B . A mask (preferably formed from photoresist material) is deposited and patterned to define amask feature 1203 as shown inFIG. 12C . Themask feature 1203 protects the area of theaperture 1205 that results from the process as shown inFIG. 12I . - Then,
mask feature 1203 is used as part of an etch operation that etches through the exposedprotective layer 1201 andunderlying guide layer 1035 to a depth at or near thetop surface 1209 oflayer 1033, and thus leaving behind a post that includes theprotective layer 1201 andunderlying guide layer 1035 as shown inFIG. 12D . The post can include one or more sidewalls (such as the two opposed sidewalls 1207A, 1207B) that extend through theprotective layer 1201 andunderlying guide layer 1035 as shown. This etch operation can employ an anisotropic etching process that define a near vertical profile for the sidewall(s) of the post . An example of a suitable anisotropic etching process is dry reactive ion etching employing SF6. - Then, one or more implant regions such as two
implant regions top surface 1209 into the layer structure outside the post as shown inFIG. 12E . In one embodiment, the one or more implant regions (e.g.,regions type layers 1031 of the layer structure ofFIG. 10 . In this case, the one or more implant regions (e.g.,implant regions regions QW structure 1027. This requires higher energy to place the implant region(s) below such QW(s). In this case, the one or more implant regions (e.g.,regions QW structure 1027. The larger barrier means that p-type conduction over this barrier is reduced and so the hole current from the top contact flows laterally where the barrier is lower (i.e., the vertically down conduction is blocked) preferentially to the un-implanted active region of the device structure disposed below the post. The ions species of the implant region(s) can be Si ions due to its lower mass and larger possible range. SiF ions may also be used. The advantage of locating the current blocking implant region(s) below the QW of the n-type modulation dopedQW structure 1027 is that the top p-type layers 1031 can be made thinner (preferably a 1/2 λ above the QW), which makes it easier to fabricate HFETs with a lower profile topology. Another advantage of this approach is a lower laser resistance and therefore reduced heat generation in the laser active region which is important for stable laser operation in the integrated environment. The implant region(s) (e.g.,regions 211A, 1211B) can also provide for lateral confinement of light within the active region of the device structure disposed below the post. - Next, the
protective layer 1201 of the post is removed and thenmetal material 1213 for the top surface electrode, which can be tungsten or some other suitable metal or metal alloy, is deposited and patterned such that it covers thetop surface 1209 oflayer 1033 and the top surface and sidewalls of theguide layer 1035 of the post as evident fromFIG. 12F . - Next, a second mask layer 1215 (preferably formed from photoresist material) is deposited and patterned to define a
window 1216 that overlies themetal feature 1213 and theguide layer 1035 of the post as shown inFIG. 12G . Thewindow 1216 is used as part of an etch operation that etches down through themetal 1213 to a depth at or near the top surface of theguide layer 1035 in the area that results in theaperture 1205. This etch operation can employ a BOE (Buffered Oxide Etch) that etches sideways and removes the top section of the exposedmetal feature 1213 to form the resultant structure as shown inFIG. 12H . Thesecond mask layer 1215 is then removed to form the structure as shown in 121 where theaperture 1205 is formed between the opposedsurface electrode parts - Note that the current blocking implant region(s) (e.g.,
implant regions aperture 1205 below the correspondingsurface electrode parts implant regions surface electrode parts aperture 1215. This self-aligned configuration of the implant region(s) and the surface electrode is advantageous because it can eliminate fabrication steps, aid in minimizing resistance of the top surface layers and aid in producing uniformity and higher yield over large areas. - In alternate embodiments, similar methodology can be used to form a passive and/or active in-plane waveguide structures as part of optoelectronic device realized in an integrated circuit that employs the layer structure of
FIG. 10 . Such in-plane waveguide guides the propagation of light in the plane of the integrated circuit, and the waveguide layer of the post feature formed at the top surface provides for wave guiding of the in-plane propagating light at the top portion of the integrated circuit wafer. For the passive in-plane waveguide structure, the patterned metal can be omitted. - In other alternate embodiments, the surface electrode that defines the boundaries of the
aperture 1205 can be patterned and etched away after metallizing all of the electrodes of the devices of the integrated circuit and prior to depositing the dielectric material of the top mirror of such device, if used. - There have been described and illustrated herein several embodiments of an optoelectronic integrated circuit employing complementary modulation doped quantum well structures and methods of fabricating the same. While particular embodiments of the invention have been described, it is not intended that the invention be limited thereto, as it is intended that the invention be as broad in scope as the art will allow and that the specification be read likewise. Thus, while particular group III-V material system and heterostructures have been disclosed, it will be appreciated that other III-V material systems and heterostructures can be used to realize the optoelectronic integrated circuitry as described herein. It will therefore be appreciated by those skilled in the art that yet other modifications could be made to the provided invention without deviating from its spirit and scope as claimed.
Claims (9)
Priority Applications (1)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US15/450,400 US10038302B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2017-03-06 | Optoelectronic integrated circuit |
Applications Claiming Priority (3)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US201461962303P | 2014-01-29 | 2014-01-29 | |
US14/222,841 US9625647B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2014-03-24 | Optoelectronic integrated circuit |
US15/450,400 US10038302B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2017-03-06 | Optoelectronic integrated circuit |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/222,841 Continuation US9625647B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2014-03-24 | Optoelectronic integrated circuit |
Publications (2)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20170222400A1 true US20170222400A1 (en) | 2017-08-03 |
US10038302B2 US10038302B2 (en) | 2018-07-31 |
Family
ID=53679844
Family Applications (4)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/222,841 Active US9625647B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2014-03-24 | Optoelectronic integrated circuit |
US15/450,400 Active US10038302B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2017-03-06 | Optoelectronic integrated circuit |
US15/450,282 Active US10601198B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2017-03-06 | Dual wavelength hybrid device |
US15/450,351 Active US10811841B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2017-03-06 | Split-electrode vertical cavity optical device |
Family Applications Before (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/222,841 Active US9625647B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2014-03-24 | Optoelectronic integrated circuit |
Family Applications After (2)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US15/450,282 Active US10601198B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2017-03-06 | Dual wavelength hybrid device |
US15/450,351 Active US10811841B2 (en) | 2014-01-29 | 2017-03-06 | Split-electrode vertical cavity optical device |
Country Status (2)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (4) | US9625647B2 (en) |
WO (1) | WO2015116435A2 (en) |
Cited By (4)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US10116115B2 (en) | 2017-02-22 | 2018-10-30 | Geoff W. Taylor | Integrated circuit implementing a VCSEL array or VCSEL device |
WO2021188455A1 (en) * | 2020-03-14 | 2021-09-23 | Luminous Computing, Inc. | Digital-to-analog converter system and method of operation |
US11656485B2 (en) | 2019-07-11 | 2023-05-23 | Luminous Computing, Inc. | Photonic bandgap phase modulator, optical filter bank, photonic computing system, and methods of use |
WO2023192081A1 (en) * | 2022-03-29 | 2023-10-05 | Taylor Geoff W | Semiconductor optoelectronic integrated circuit and methodology for making same employing gate-all-around epitaxial structures |
Families Citing this family (32)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US9625647B2 (en) * | 2014-01-29 | 2017-04-18 | The University Of Connecticut | Optoelectronic integrated circuit |
JP5914605B2 (en) * | 2014-09-19 | 2016-05-11 | 株式会社東芝 | Semiconductor photo detector |
DE102015102300A1 (en) | 2015-02-18 | 2016-08-18 | Osram Opto Semiconductors Gmbh | Method for producing an electronic component |
US10509172B2 (en) * | 2015-07-20 | 2019-12-17 | The University Of Queensland | Tunable optical device |
KR102384228B1 (en) * | 2015-09-30 | 2022-04-07 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Semiconductor laser resonator and Semiconductor laser device having the same |
US9748735B2 (en) * | 2015-10-08 | 2017-08-29 | The University Of North Carolina At Charlotte | Light-effect transistor (LET) |
US10451548B2 (en) * | 2016-01-15 | 2019-10-22 | The Mitre Corporation | Active hyperspectral imaging system |
US10418517B2 (en) | 2016-02-23 | 2019-09-17 | Silanna UV Technologies Pte Ltd | Resonant optical cavity light emitting device |
WO2017145026A1 (en) * | 2016-02-23 | 2017-08-31 | Silanna UV Technologies Pte Ltd | Resonant optical cavity light emitting device |
WO2017200620A2 (en) * | 2016-02-29 | 2017-11-23 | Stc.Unm | Ring laser integrated with silicon-on-insulator waveguide |
US10297699B2 (en) * | 2016-05-27 | 2019-05-21 | The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary Of The Navy | In-plane resonant-cavity infrared photodetectors with fully-depleted absorbers |
US10761266B2 (en) * | 2016-06-03 | 2020-09-01 | The Regents Of The University Of California | Integration of direct-bandgap optically active devices on indirect-bandgap-based substrates |
US10461216B2 (en) * | 2016-09-23 | 2019-10-29 | Wright State University | Gallium nitride cross-gap light emitters based on unipolar-doped tunneling structures |
JP7077500B2 (en) * | 2017-01-12 | 2022-05-31 | ローム株式会社 | Surface emitting laser element, optical device |
JP6888338B2 (en) * | 2017-03-09 | 2021-06-16 | 住友電気工業株式会社 | Semiconductor laser |
JP6926542B2 (en) * | 2017-03-10 | 2021-08-25 | 住友電気工業株式会社 | Semiconductor laser |
US11658453B2 (en) * | 2018-01-29 | 2023-05-23 | Ronald LaComb | Concentric cylindrical circumferential laser |
RU193300U1 (en) * | 2018-03-27 | 2019-10-22 | Федеральное государственное бюджетное учреждение науки Физико-технический институт им. А.Ф. Иоффе Российской академии наук | SEMICONDUCTOR SOURCE OF INFRARED RADIATION |
CN109038182A (en) * | 2018-08-14 | 2018-12-18 | 中国科学院半导体研究所 | A kind of THz wave transmitter |
CN110828022B (en) * | 2018-08-14 | 2021-11-19 | 华为技术有限公司 | Ion optical cavity coupling system and method |
US11418006B1 (en) * | 2018-09-17 | 2022-08-16 | Apple Inc. | Integrated device for optical time-of-flight measurement |
US10622514B1 (en) | 2018-10-15 | 2020-04-14 | Silanna UV Technologies Pte Ltd | Resonant optical cavity light emitting device |
US10731988B1 (en) * | 2019-07-10 | 2020-08-04 | Anello Photonics, Inc. | System architecture for integrated photonics optical gyroscopes |
US11506496B2 (en) | 2019-07-10 | 2022-11-22 | Anello Photonics, Inc. | System architecture for integrated photonics optical gyroscopes |
US11508677B2 (en) * | 2019-08-29 | 2022-11-22 | Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Company Ltd. | Semiconductor package for high-speed data transmission and manufacturing method thereof |
CN110931575B (en) * | 2019-10-24 | 2021-05-18 | 重庆邮电大学 | Waveguide photodetector monolithically integrated with DBR cladding and reflector |
CN111180545B (en) * | 2020-01-17 | 2021-06-22 | 淮阴工学院 | Low-dimensional material heterojunction photoelectric detector integrated with waveguide |
US10951003B1 (en) * | 2020-02-25 | 2021-03-16 | Inphi Corporation | Light source for integrated silicon photonics |
CN111181001B (en) * | 2020-03-04 | 2021-06-29 | 常州纵慧芯光半导体科技有限公司 | Vertical cavity surface emitting laser and manufacturing method and application thereof |
US11227765B1 (en) * | 2020-07-17 | 2022-01-18 | National Yang Ming Chiao Tung University | Self-organized quantum dot manufacturing method and quantum dot semiconductor structure |
US11799268B2 (en) | 2020-08-24 | 2023-10-24 | Geoff W. Taylor | Semiconductor integrated circuit and methodology for making same |
WO2023211900A1 (en) * | 2022-04-26 | 2023-11-02 | Aayuna Inc. | Passive alignment configuration for use with optical waveguides formed within adjoining substrates |
Citations (2)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20020121647A1 (en) * | 2001-03-02 | 2002-09-05 | Taylor Geoff W. | Modulation doped thyristor and complementary transistor combination for a monolithic optoelectronic integrated circuit |
US6965128B2 (en) * | 2003-02-03 | 2005-11-15 | Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. | Structure and method for fabricating semiconductor microresonator devices |
Family Cites Families (24)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US4683637A (en) | 1986-02-07 | 1987-08-04 | Motorola, Inc. | Forming depthwise isolation by selective oxygen/nitrogen deep implant and reaction annealing |
US5115442A (en) | 1990-04-13 | 1992-05-19 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Top-emitting surface emitting laser structures |
US5034958A (en) | 1990-04-19 | 1991-07-23 | Bell Communications Research, Inc. | Front-surface emitting diode laser |
JPH0770792B2 (en) | 1993-02-26 | 1995-07-31 | 日本電気株式会社 | Surface emitting laser and manufacturing method thereof |
US6031243A (en) * | 1996-10-16 | 2000-02-29 | Geoff W. Taylor | Grating coupled vertical cavity optoelectronic devices |
US6849866B2 (en) | 1996-10-16 | 2005-02-01 | The University Of Connecticut | High performance optoelectronic and electronic inversion channel quantum well devices suitable for monolithic integration |
US6870207B2 (en) | 2000-04-24 | 2005-03-22 | The University Of Connecticut | III-V charge coupled device suitable for visible, near and far infra-red detection |
US7247892B2 (en) * | 2000-04-24 | 2007-07-24 | Taylor Geoff W | Imaging array utilizing thyristor-based pixel elements |
JP2002217484A (en) | 2001-01-18 | 2002-08-02 | Fujitsu Ltd | Optical semiconductor device |
US6975661B2 (en) | 2001-06-14 | 2005-12-13 | Finisar Corporation | Method and apparatus for producing VCSELS with dielectric mirrors and self-aligned gain guide |
US6940878B2 (en) | 2002-05-14 | 2005-09-06 | Lambda Crossing Ltd. | Tunable laser using microring resonator |
US6841795B2 (en) | 2002-10-25 | 2005-01-11 | The University Of Connecticut | Semiconductor devices employing at least one modulation doped quantum well structure and one or more etch stop layers for accurate contact formation |
US6873273B2 (en) | 2002-10-25 | 2005-03-29 | The University Of Connecticut | Photonic serial digital-to-analog converter employing a heterojunction thyristor device |
US6954473B2 (en) | 2002-10-25 | 2005-10-11 | Opel, Inc. | Optoelectronic device employing at least one semiconductor heterojunction thyristor for producing variable electrical/optical delay |
US6995407B2 (en) | 2002-10-25 | 2006-02-07 | The University Of Connecticut | Photonic digital-to-analog converter employing a plurality of heterojunction thyristor devices |
US7332752B2 (en) | 2002-10-25 | 2008-02-19 | The University Of Connecticut | Optoelectronic circuit employing a heterojunction thyristor device to convert a digital optical signal to a digital electrical signal |
US6853014B2 (en) | 2002-10-25 | 2005-02-08 | The University Of Connecticut | Optoelectronic circuit employing a heterojunction thyristor device that performs high speed sampling |
US8877101B2 (en) * | 2007-05-31 | 2014-11-04 | Nthdegree Technologies Worldwide Inc | Method of manufacturing a light emitting, power generating or other electronic apparatus |
US7668420B2 (en) * | 2007-07-26 | 2010-02-23 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Optical waveguide ring resonator with an intracavity active element |
US8274039B2 (en) * | 2008-11-13 | 2012-09-25 | Zena Technologies, Inc. | Vertical waveguides with various functionality on integrated circuits |
US20100236625A1 (en) * | 2009-02-20 | 2010-09-23 | John Kenney | Solar Modules Including Spectral Concentrators and Related Manufacturing Methods |
EP2745154A4 (en) | 2011-08-18 | 2015-07-01 | Opel Solar Inc | Optical closed loop microresonator and thyristor memory device |
US9082637B2 (en) | 2012-08-17 | 2015-07-14 | The University Of Connecticut | Optoelectronic integrated circuit |
US9625647B2 (en) * | 2014-01-29 | 2017-04-18 | The University Of Connecticut | Optoelectronic integrated circuit |
-
2014
- 2014-03-24 US US14/222,841 patent/US9625647B2/en active Active
-
2015
- 2015-01-20 WO PCT/US2015/012033 patent/WO2015116435A2/en active Application Filing
-
2017
- 2017-03-06 US US15/450,400 patent/US10038302B2/en active Active
- 2017-03-06 US US15/450,282 patent/US10601198B2/en active Active
- 2017-03-06 US US15/450,351 patent/US10811841B2/en active Active
Patent Citations (2)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20020121647A1 (en) * | 2001-03-02 | 2002-09-05 | Taylor Geoff W. | Modulation doped thyristor and complementary transistor combination for a monolithic optoelectronic integrated circuit |
US6965128B2 (en) * | 2003-02-03 | 2005-11-15 | Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. | Structure and method for fabricating semiconductor microresonator devices |
Cited By (5)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US10116115B2 (en) | 2017-02-22 | 2018-10-30 | Geoff W. Taylor | Integrated circuit implementing a VCSEL array or VCSEL device |
US11656485B2 (en) | 2019-07-11 | 2023-05-23 | Luminous Computing, Inc. | Photonic bandgap phase modulator, optical filter bank, photonic computing system, and methods of use |
WO2021188455A1 (en) * | 2020-03-14 | 2021-09-23 | Luminous Computing, Inc. | Digital-to-analog converter system and method of operation |
US11211941B2 (en) | 2020-03-14 | 2021-12-28 | Luminous Computing, Inc. | Digital-to-analog converter system and method of operation |
WO2023192081A1 (en) * | 2022-03-29 | 2023-10-05 | Taylor Geoff W | Semiconductor optoelectronic integrated circuit and methodology for making same employing gate-all-around epitaxial structures |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
US20150214425A1 (en) | 2015-07-30 |
US10038302B2 (en) | 2018-07-31 |
US10811841B2 (en) | 2020-10-20 |
WO2015116435A3 (en) | 2015-12-10 |
US10601198B2 (en) | 2020-03-24 |
US20170221995A1 (en) | 2017-08-03 |
US9625647B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 |
WO2015116435A2 (en) | 2015-08-06 |
US20170179684A1 (en) | 2017-06-22 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US10038302B2 (en) | Optoelectronic integrated circuit | |
US9401400B2 (en) | Single electron transistor device | |
US6936839B2 (en) | Monolithic integrated circuit including a waveguide and quantum well inversion channel devices and a method of fabricating same | |
EP3586369B1 (en) | Integrated circuit implementing a vcsel array or vcsel device | |
KR101300298B1 (en) | Nitride semiconductor vertical cavity surface emitting laser | |
US9904015B2 (en) | Optoelectronic integrated circuitry for transmitting and/or receiving wavelength-division multiplexed optical signals | |
US20050063440A1 (en) | Epitaxial mode-confined vertical cavity surface emitting laser (VCSEL) and method of manufacturing same | |
US11799268B2 (en) | Semiconductor integrated circuit and methodology for making same | |
CN107611776B (en) | Gain coupling distributed feedback semiconductor laser and manufacturing method thereof | |
US9679987B2 (en) | Fabrication methodology for optoelectronic integrated circuits | |
CN112072466A (en) | Semiconductor laser and preparation method thereof | |
US9590136B2 (en) | Semiconductor device for optoelectronic integrated circuits | |
US9755060B2 (en) | Fabrication methodology for optoelectronic integrated circuits | |
US9490336B1 (en) | Fabrication methodology for optoelectronic integrated circuits | |
US9450124B1 (en) | Fabrication methodology for optoelectronic integrated circuits | |
US20230317819A1 (en) | Semiconductor optoelectronic integrated circuit and methodology for making same employing gate-all-around epitaxial structures | |
TW202403369A (en) | Semiconductor optoelectronic integrated circuit and methodology for making same employing gate-all-around epitaxial structures |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
STCF | Information on status: patent grant |
Free format text: PATENTED CASE |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: ESPRESSO CAPITAL LTD., CANADA Free format text: SECURITY INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:OPEL INC.;REEL/FRAME:048886/0716 Effective date: 20190326 |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: ESPRESSO CAPITAL LTD., CANADA Free format text: CORRECTIVE ASSIGNMENT TO CORRECT THE EXECUTION DATE PREVIOUSLY RECORDED AT REEL: 048886 FRAME: 0716. ASSIGNOR(S) HEREBY CONFIRMS THE SECURITY INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:BB PHOTONICS INC.;REEL/FRAME:048947/0480 Effective date: 20190418 |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: OPEL INC., CALIFORNIA Free format text: RELEASE BY SECURED PARTY;ASSIGNOR:ESPRESSO CAPITAL LTD.;REEL/FRAME:051069/0619 Effective date: 20191107 |
|
MAFP | Maintenance fee payment |
Free format text: PAYMENT OF MAINTENANCE FEE, 4TH YR, SMALL ENTITY (ORIGINAL EVENT CODE: M2551); ENTITY STATUS OF PATENT OWNER: SMALL ENTITY Year of fee payment: 4 |